blob: e756d41e344640f97779c130fe13bdd4c1d97e62 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaucfe14662017-11-19 09:55:29 +01007 2017/11/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200545 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200546 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100548 - presetenv
549 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - uid
551 - ulimit-n
552 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100553 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200554 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200555 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-bind-options
557 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
558 - ssl-default-server-options
559 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100560 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100561 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100562 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100563 - 51degrees-data-file
564 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200565 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200566 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100567 - wurfl-data-file
568 - wurfl-information-list
569 - wurfl-information-list-separator
570 - wurfl-engine-mode
571 - wurfl-cache-size
572 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100573
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200575 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200577 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100578 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100579 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100580 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200581 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200582 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200583 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200584 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200585 - noepoll
586 - nokqueue
587 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100588 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300589 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000590 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200591 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200592 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200593 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000594 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000595 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200596 - tune.buffers.limit
597 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200598 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200599 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100600 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200601 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200602 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200603 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100604 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200605 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200606 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100607 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100608 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100609 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100610 - tune.lua.session-timeout
611 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200612 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100613 - tune.maxaccept
614 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200615 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200616 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200617 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100618 - tune.rcvbuf.client
619 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100620 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100621 - tune.sndbuf.client
622 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100623 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100624 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200625 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100626 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200627 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200628 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100629 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200630 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100631 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200632 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
633 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
634 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100635 - tune.zlib.memlevel
636 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100637
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200638 * Debugging
639 - debug
640 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641
642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006433.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644------------------------------------
645
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200646ca-base <dir>
647 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200648 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
649 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200650
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651chroot <jail dir>
652 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
653 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
654 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
655 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
656 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
657 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100658
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100659cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
660 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
661 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
662 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
663 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
664 set. These sets have the format
665
666 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
667
668 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
669 word size. any process IDs above nbrpoc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
670 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
671 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100672 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
673 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
674 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
675 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100676 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
677 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
678 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
679 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
680 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
681 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100682
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100683 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
684 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
685 on the machine's word size.
686
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100687 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100688 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
689 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
690 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
691 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
692 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
693 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100694
695 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100696 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
697
698 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
699 # first 4 CPUs
700
701 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
702 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
703 # word size.
704
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100705 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100706 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100707 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
708 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
709 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
710
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
712 # and so on.
713 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
714 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
715 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
716
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100717 # bind each process to exaclty one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
718 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
719 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
720 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
721
722 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
723 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
724 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
725
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100726 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
727 # and a thread range.
728 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
729 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
730 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
731
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200732crt-base <dir>
733 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
734 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
735 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737daemon
738 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
739 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100740 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
741 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200742
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200743deviceatlas-json-file <path>
744 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
745 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
746
747deviceatlas-log-level <value>
748 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
749 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
750
751deviceatlas-separator <char>
752 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
753 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
754
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100755deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200756 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
757 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
758 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100759
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900760external-check
761 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
762 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
763 See "option external-check".
764
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200765gid <number>
766 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
767 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
768 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100769 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
770 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100772
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100773hard-stop-after <time>
774 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
775
776 Arguments :
777 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
778 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
779 SIGUSR1 signal.
780
781 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
782 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
783 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
784
785 Example:
786 global
787 hard-stop-after 30s
788
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200789group <group name>
790 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
791 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100792
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200793log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
795 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100796 configured with "log global".
797
798 <address> can be one of:
799
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100800 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100801 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
802 port).
803
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100804 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
805 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
806 port).
807
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100808 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
809 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
810 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
811 writeable).
812
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200813 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
814 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100815
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200816 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
817 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
818 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
819 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
820 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
821 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
822 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
823 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
824 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
825 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200826 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
827 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200828
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200829 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
830 one of the following :
831
832 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
833 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
834
835 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
836 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
837
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100838 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200839
840 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
841 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
842 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
843
844 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200845 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
846 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
847 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
848 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
849 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
850 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200852 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100854log-send-hostname [<string>]
855 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
856 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
857 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
858 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
859 the logs.
860
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000861log-tag <string>
862 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
863 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
864 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100865 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000866
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100867lua-load <file>
868 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
869 used multiple times.
870
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200871master-worker [exit-on-failure]
872 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
873 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
874 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
875 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
876 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
877 systemd.
878 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
879 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
880 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
881 the whole process.
882
883 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
884
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200885nbproc <number>
886 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
887 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
888 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
889 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
890 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
891
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200892nbthread <number>
893 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
894 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
895 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
896 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
897 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
898
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200899pidfile <pidfile>
900 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
901 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
902 starting the process. See also "daemon".
903
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100904presetenv <name> <value>
905 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
906 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
907 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
908 and "unsetenv".
909
910resetenv [<name> ...]
911 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
912 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
913 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
914 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
915 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
916 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
917 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
918 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
919
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100920stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200921 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
922 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
923 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
924 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
925 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
926 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100927 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100928 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
929 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
930 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
931 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200932
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200933server-state-base <directory>
934 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200935 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
936 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200937
938server-state-file <file>
939 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
940 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
941 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
942 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
943 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
944 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
945 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
946 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200947 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
948 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200949
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100950setenv <name> <value>
951 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
952 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
953 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
954 and "unsetenv".
955
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100956ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
957 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
958 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300959 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100960 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
961 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
962 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
963 "bind" keyword for more information.
964
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100965ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
967 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
968 keyword to see available options.
969
970 Example:
971 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200972 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100973
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100974ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
975 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
976 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300977 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100978 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
979 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
980 information.
981
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100982ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
983 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
984 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
985 keyword to see available options.
986
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200987ssl-dh-param-file <file>
988 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
989 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
990 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
991 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
992 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200993 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
994 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
995 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
996 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200997 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
998 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
999 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1000
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001001ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1002 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1003 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1004 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1005
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001006stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1007 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1008 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1009 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001010 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001011 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001012
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001013 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1014 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1015 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001016
1017stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1018 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1019 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001020 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001021
1022stats maxconn <connections>
1023 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1024 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1025
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001026uid <number>
1027 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1028 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1029 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1030 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1031
1032ulimit-n <number>
1033 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1034 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1035 option.
1036
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001037unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1038 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1039
1040 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1041 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1042 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1043 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1044 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1045 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1046 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1047 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1048 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1049 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1050
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001051unsetenv [<name> ...]
1052 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1053 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1054 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1055 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1056 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1057 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1058 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1059
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060user <user name>
1061 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1062 See also "uid" and "group".
1063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001064node <name>
1065 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1066
1067 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1068 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1069 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1070 traffic.
1071
1072description <text>
1073 Add a text that describes the instance.
1074
1075 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1076 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1077 "<" and ">" characters.
1078
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100107951degrees-data-file <file path>
1080 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1081 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1082
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001083 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001084 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1085
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000108651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001087 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1088 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1089 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1090
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001091 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001092 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1093
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200109451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001095 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1096 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1097
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001098 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1099 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1100
110151degrees-cache-size <number>
1102 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1103 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1104 By default, this cache is disabled.
1105
1106 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001107 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1108
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001109wurfl-data-file <file path>
1110 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1111 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1112
1113 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1114 with USE_WURFL=1.
1115
1116wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1117 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1118 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1119 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1120
1121 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1122
1123 Valid WURFL properties are:
1124 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1125
1126 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1127 device.
1128
1129 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1130 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1131
1132 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1133 particular web request.
1134
1135 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1136 used Libwurfl API version.
1137
1138 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1139 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1140 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1141
1142 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1143 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1144
1145 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1146 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1147
1148 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1149
1150 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1151
1152 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1153 with USE_WURFL=1.
1154
1155wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1156 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1157 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1158
1159 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1160 with USE_WURFL=1.
1161
1162wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1163 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1164 thus before the chroot.
1165
1166 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1167 with USE_WURFL=1.
1168
1169wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1170 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1171 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1172 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1173 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1174 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1175 mode is enabled by default.
1176
1177 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1178 with USE_WURFL=1.
1179
1180wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1181 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1182 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1183 - "0" : no cache is used.
1184 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1185 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1186 the highest performing option.
1187
1188 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1189 with USE_WURFL=1.
1190
1191wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1192 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1193 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1194
1195 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1196 with USE_WURFL=1.
1197
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011993.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001200-----------------------
1201
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001202max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1203 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1204 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1205 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1206 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1207 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1208 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1209 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1210 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1211
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001212maxconn <number>
1213 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1214 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1215 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001216 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1217 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1218 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1219 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001220 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1221 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1222 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1223 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1224 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001225
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001226maxconnrate <number>
1227 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1228 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1229 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1230 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1231 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1232 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1233 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1234 fairness.
1235
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001236maxcomprate <number>
1237 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001238 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001239 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1240 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1241 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1242 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1243 default value.
1244
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001245maxcompcpuusage <number>
1246 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1247 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1248 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1249 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1250 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1251 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1252 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1253 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1254
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001255maxpipes <number>
1256 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1257 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1258 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1259 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1260 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1261 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1262
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001263maxsessrate <number>
1264 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1265 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1266 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1267 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1268 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1269 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1270 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1271 fairness.
1272
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001273maxsslconn <number>
1274 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1275 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1276 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1277 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1278 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1279 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1280 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001281 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1282 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1283 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1284 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1285 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1286 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1287 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001288
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001289maxsslrate <number>
1290 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1291 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1292 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1293 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1294 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1295 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1296 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1297 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1298 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1299 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1300
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001301maxzlibmem <number>
1302 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1303 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1304 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001305 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1306 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1307 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1308
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001309noepoll
1310 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1311 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001312 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001313
1314nokqueue
1315 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1316 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1317 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1318
1319nopoll
1320 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1321 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001322 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001323 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001324
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001325nosplice
1326 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1327 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1328 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001329 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001330 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1331 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1332 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1333 "option splice-response".
1334
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001335nogetaddrinfo
1336 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1337 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1338
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001339noreuseport
1340 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1341 command line argument "-dR".
1342
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001343spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001344 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1345 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1346 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1347 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1348 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1349 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001350
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001351ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1352 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1353 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1354 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1355 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1356 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1357 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1358 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1359 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1360 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1361 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1362 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1363 openssl configuration file uses:
1364 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1365
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001366ssl-mode-async
1367 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001368 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001369 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1370 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1371 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1372 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1373 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001374
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001375tune.buffers.limit <number>
1376 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1377 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1378 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1379 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1380 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1381 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1382 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1383 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1384 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1385 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1386 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1387 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1388 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1389 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1390 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1391
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001392tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1393 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1394 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1395 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1396 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1397
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001398tune.bufsize <number>
1399 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1400 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1401 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1402 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1403 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1404 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1405 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001406 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1407 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1408 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001409 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1410 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001411
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001412tune.chksize <number>
1413 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1414 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1415 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1416 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1417 checks whenever possible.
1418
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001419tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1420 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1421 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1422 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1423 this value. The default value is 1.
1424
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001425tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1426 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1427 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1428 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1429 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1430 change it.
1431
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001432tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1433 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
1434 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgement from haproxy. This setting
1435 only affects payload contents (ie: the body of POST requests), not headers.
1436 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1437 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1438 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1439 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1440 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1441
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001442tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1443 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1444 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1445 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1446 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1447 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1448 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1449 recommended not to change this value.
1450
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001451tune.http.cookielen <number>
1452 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1453 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1454 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1455 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1456 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1457 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1458 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1459 to change this value.
1460
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001461tune.http.logurilen <number>
1462 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1463 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1464 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1465 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1466 configuration directives too.
1467 The default value is 1024.
1468
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001469tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1470 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1471 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1472 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1473 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1474 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1475 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001476 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1477 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1478 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001479
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001480tune.idletimer <timeout>
1481 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1482 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1483 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1484 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1485 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1486 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1487 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1488 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1489 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1490
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001491tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1492 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001493 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001494 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1495 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1496 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1497 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1498 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1499
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001500tune.lua.maxmem
1501 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1502 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1503 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1504 memory.
1505
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001506tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1507 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001508 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1509 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1510 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001511
1512tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1513 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1514 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1515 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1516 check servers.
1517
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001518tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1519 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1520 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1521 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1522 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1523
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001524tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001525 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1526 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1527 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1528 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1529 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1530 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1531 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1532 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1533 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1534 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001535
1536tune.maxpollevents <number>
1537 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1538 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1539 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1540 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1541 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1542
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001543tune.maxrewrite <number>
1544 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1545 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1546 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1547 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1548 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1549 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1550 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1551 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1552 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1553 bufsize.
1554
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001555tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1556 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1557 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1558 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1559 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1560 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1561 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1562 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1563 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1564 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1565 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1566 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1567 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1568 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1569 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1570 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1571 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1572 setting this parameter to 0.
1573
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001574tune.pipesize <number>
1575 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1576 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1577 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1578 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1579 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1580 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1581
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001582tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1583tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1584 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1585 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1586 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1587 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1588 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1589 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1590 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1591
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001592tune.recv_enough <number>
1593 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1594 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1595 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1596 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1597 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1598
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001599tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1600tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1601 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1602 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1603 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1604 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1605 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1606 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1607 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1608 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1609 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1610 notifying haproxy again.
1611
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001612tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001613 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1614 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1615 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001616 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001617 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1618 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1619 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1620 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1621 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001622 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1623 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001624
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001625tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1626 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1627 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1628 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1629 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1630 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1631 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1632
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001633tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1634 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001635 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001636 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1637 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1638 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1639 being used for too long.
1640
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001641tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1642 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1643 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1644 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1645 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1646 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1647 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1648 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1649 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1650 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1651 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001652 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1653 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001654
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001655tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1656 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1657 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1658 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1659 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1660 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1661 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1662 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001663 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1664 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001665
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001666tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1667 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1668 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1669 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1670 1000 entries.
1671
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001672tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1673 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1674 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1675 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1676
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001677tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001678tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001679tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1680tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1681tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001682 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1683 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1684 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1685 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1686 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1687 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1688 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1689 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001690
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001691 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1692 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1693 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1694 all available space is consumed.
1695 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1696 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1697 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001698
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001699tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1700 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001701 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001702 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1703 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1704 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1705
1706tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1707 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1708 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1709 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1710 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001711
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017123.3. Debugging
1713--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001714
1715debug
1716 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1717 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1718 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1719 system startup.
1720
1721quiet
1722 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1723 line argument "-q".
1724
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017263.4. Userlists
1727--------------
1728It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1729http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1730it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1731
1732userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001733 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001734 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1735
1736group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001737 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001738 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1739 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1740
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001741user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1742 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001743 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1744 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001745 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1746 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1747 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1748 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001749
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001750 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1751 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1752 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1753 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1754 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1755 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1756 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1757 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1758 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001759
1760 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001761 userlist L1
1762 group G1 users tiger,scott
1763 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001764
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001765 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1766 user scott insecure-password elgato
1767 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001768
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001769 userlist L2
1770 group G1
1771 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001772
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001773 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1774 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1775 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001776
1777 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001778
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001779
17803.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001781----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001782It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1783several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1784instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1785values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1786automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1787In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1788using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1789tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1790reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1791Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1792that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1793each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001794
1795peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001796 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001797 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1798
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001799disabled
1800 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1801 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1802 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1803
1804enable
1805 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1806
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001807peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1808 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1809 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1810 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1811 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1812 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1813 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1814
1815 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1816 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1817
1818 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1819 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1820 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1821 across all peers.
1822
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001823 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1824 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001825
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001826 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001827 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001828 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1829 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1830 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001831
1832 backend mybackend
1833 mode tcp
1834 balance roundrobin
1835 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1836 stick on src
1837
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001838 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1839 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001840
1841
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090018423.6. Mailers
1843------------
1844It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1845If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1846in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1847
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001848mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001849 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1850 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1851
1852mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1853 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1854
1855 Example:
1856 mailers mymailers
1857 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1858 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1859
1860 backend mybackend
1861 mode tcp
1862 balance roundrobin
1863
1864 email-alert mailers mymailers
1865 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1866 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1867
1868 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1869 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1870
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001871timeout mail <time>
1872 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1873 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1874 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1875 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1876
1877 Example:
1878 mailers mymailers
1879 timeout mail 20s
1880 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018824. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001883----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001884
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001885Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001886 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001887 - frontend <name>
1888 - backend <name>
1889 - listen <name>
1890
1891A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1892its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1893section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001895
1896A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1897connections.
1898
1899A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1900to forward incoming connections.
1901
1902A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1903parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1904
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001905All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1906'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1907case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1908
1909Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1910logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1911proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1912However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1913name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1914
1915Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1916and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001917bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001918protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1919modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1920arbitrary criteria.
1921
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001922In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1923a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1924the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1925
1926 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1927 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1928 between responses and new requests.
1929
1930 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1931 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1932 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1933 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1934
1935 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1936 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1937 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1938
1939 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1940 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1941 client-facing connection remains open.
1942
1943 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1944 after the end of the response.
1945
1946The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1947frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1948following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1949weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1950
1951 Backend mode
1952
1953 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1954 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1955 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1956 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1957 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1958 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1959 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1960 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1961 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1962 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1963 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019674.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1968--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001970The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1971limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1972they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1973limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001974marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001975option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001976and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1977with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1978specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001979
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001980
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001981 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1982------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1983acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001984appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001985backlog X X X -
1986balance X - X X
1987bind - X X -
1988bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001989block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001990capture cookie - X X -
1991capture request header - X X -
1992capture response header - X X -
1993clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001994compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001995contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1996cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001997declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001998default-server X - X X
1999default_backend X X X -
2000description - X X X
2001disabled X X X X
2002dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002003email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002004email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002005email-alert mailers X X X X
2006email-alert myhostname X X X X
2007email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002008enabled X X X X
2009errorfile X X X X
2010errorloc X X X X
2011errorloc302 X X X X
2012-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2013errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002014force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002015filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002016fullconn X - X X
2017grace X X X X
2018hash-type X - X X
2019http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002020http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002021http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002022http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002023http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002024http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002025http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002026id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002027ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002028load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002029log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002030log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002031log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002032log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002033max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002034maxconn X X X -
2035mode X X X X
2036monitor fail - X X -
2037monitor-net X X X -
2038monitor-uri X X X -
2039option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2040option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2041option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2042option allbackups (*) X - X X
2043option checkcache (*) X - X X
2044option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2045option contstats (*) X X X -
2046option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2047option dontlognull (*) X X X -
2048option forceclose (*) X X X X
2049-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2050option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002051option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002052option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002053option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002054option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002055option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002056option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01002057option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002058option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2059option httpchk X - X X
2060option httpclose (*) X X X X
2061option httplog X X X X
2062option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002063option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002064option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002065option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002066option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2067option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2068option logasap (*) X X X -
2069option mysql-check X - X X
2070option nolinger (*) X X X X
2071option originalto X X X X
2072option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002073option pgsql-check X - X X
2074option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002075option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002076option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002077option smtpchk X - X X
2078option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2079option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2080option splice-request (*) X X X X
2081option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002082option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002083option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2084option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2085-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002086option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002087option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2088option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2089option tcpka X X X X
2090option tcplog X X X X
2091option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002092external-check command X - X X
2093external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002094persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2095rate-limit sessions X X X -
2096redirect - X X X
2097redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2098redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2099reqadd - X X X
2100reqallow - X X X
2101reqdel - X X X
2102reqdeny - X X X
2103reqiallow - X X X
2104reqidel - X X X
2105reqideny - X X X
2106reqipass - X X X
2107reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002108reqitarpit - X X X
2109reqpass - X X X
2110reqrep - X X X
2111-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002112reqtarpit - X X X
2113retries X - X X
2114rspadd - X X X
2115rspdel - X X X
2116rspdeny - X X X
2117rspidel - X X X
2118rspideny - X X X
2119rspirep - X X X
2120rsprep - X X X
2121server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002122server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002123server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002124source X - X X
2125srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002126stats admin - X X X
2127stats auth X X X X
2128stats enable X X X X
2129stats hide-version X X X X
2130stats http-request - X X X
2131stats realm X X X X
2132stats refresh X X X X
2133stats scope X X X X
2134stats show-desc X X X X
2135stats show-legends X X X X
2136stats show-node X X X X
2137stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002138-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2139stick match - - X X
2140stick on - - X X
2141stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002142stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002143stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002144tcp-check connect - - X X
2145tcp-check expect - - X X
2146tcp-check send - - X X
2147tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002148tcp-request connection - X X -
2149tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002150tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002151tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002152tcp-response content - - X X
2153tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002154timeout check X - X X
2155timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002156timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002157timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2158timeout connect X - X X
2159timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2160timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2161timeout http-request X X X X
2162timeout queue X - X X
2163timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002164timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002165timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2166timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002167timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002168transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002169unique-id-format X X X -
2170unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002171use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002172use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002173------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2174 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002175
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021774.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2178---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002179
2180This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2181
2182
2183acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2184 Declare or complete an access list.
2185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2186 no | yes | yes | yes
2187 Example:
2188 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2189 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2190 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002192 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193
2194
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002195appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2196 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002197 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2199 no | no | yes | yes
2200 Arguments :
2201 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2202 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2203
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002204 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205 checked in each cookie value.
2206
2207 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2208 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2209 milliseconds.
2210
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002211 request-learn
2212 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2213 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2214 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2215 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2216 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2217 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2218
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002219 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2220 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2221 data following this prefix.
2222
2223 Example :
2224 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2225
2226 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2227 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2228
2229 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2230 2 modes are currently supported :
2231 - path-parameters :
2232 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2233 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2234 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2235 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2236 - query-string :
2237 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2238 query string.
2239
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002240 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2241 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2242 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002243
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002244 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2245 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246
2247
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002248backlog <conns>
2249 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2251 yes | yes | yes | no
2252 Arguments :
2253 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2254 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002255 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002256
2257 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2258 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2259 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2260 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2261 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2262 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2263 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2264 backlog parameter.
2265
2266 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2267 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2268 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2269
2270 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2271
2272
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002273balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002274balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002275 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2277 yes | no | yes | yes
2278 Arguments :
2279 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2280 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2281 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2282 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2283
2284 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2285 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2286 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2287 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002288 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002289 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002290 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2291 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2292 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2293 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2294 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2295 it, so that you don't worry.
2296
2297 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2298 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2299 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2300 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2301 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2302 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2303 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2304 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002306 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2307 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2308 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2309 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2310 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2311 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2312 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2313 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2314
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002315 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002316 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002317 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2318 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002319 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002320 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2321 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2322 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2323 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2324 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002325 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2326 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2327 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2328 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2329 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2330 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2333 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2334 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2335 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2336 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2337 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2338 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2339 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002340 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002341 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002342 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2343 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2344 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002346 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2347 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2348 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2349 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2350 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2351 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2352 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2353 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2354 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2355 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2356 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2357 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002358
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002359 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002360 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2361 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2362 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2363 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2364 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2365 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2366 URIs start with a leading "/".
2367
2368 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2369 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2370 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2371 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002373 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002374 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2375
2376 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002377 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2378 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002379 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2380 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2381 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2382 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002383 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002384 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2385 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002386
2387 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2388 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2389 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2390 server will receive the request.
2391
2392 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2393 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2394 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2395 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2396 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002397 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2398 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2399 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002400
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002401 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2402 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2403 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2404 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2405 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002406
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002407 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002408 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2409 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2410 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2411
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002412 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2413 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2414 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2415
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002416 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002417 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002418 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2419 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2420 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2421 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2422 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2423 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002424 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002425 used instead.
2426
2427 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2428 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2429 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2430 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2431
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002432 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2433 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2434 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2435
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002436 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002437
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002438 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002439 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2440 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002441
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002442 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2443 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2444 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002445
2446 Examples :
2447 balance roundrobin
2448 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002449 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002450 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2451 balance hdr(host)
2452 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002453
2454 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2455 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2456
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002457 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002458 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2459 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2460 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2461 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2462
2463 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2464 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2465 defaults to 16 kB.
2466
2467 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2468 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2469
2470 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2471 Round Robin.
2472
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002473 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002474 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2475 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2476 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2477
2478 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2479
2480 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002481 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002482 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2483 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2484 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002485
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002486 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002487
2488
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002489bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2490bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002491 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2493 no | yes | yes | no
2494 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002495 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2496 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2497 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2498 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002499 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002500 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2501 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2502 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2503 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2504 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2505 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2506 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002507 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2508 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2509 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2510 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2511 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2512 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2513 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002514 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2515 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2516 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002517 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2518 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2519 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002520
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002521 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2522 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002523 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2524 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2525 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002526 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2527 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2528 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2529 the range.
2530
2531 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2532 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2533 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2534 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2535 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2536 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2537 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002538 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002539 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002540
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002541 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2542 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2543 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2544 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2545 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2546 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2547 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2548 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2549
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002550 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2551 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2552 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2553 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002554
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002555 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2556 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2557 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2558 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2559 in a frontend.
2560
2561 Example :
2562 listen http_proxy
2563 bind :80,:443
2564 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002565 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002566
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002567 listen http_https_proxy
2568 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002569 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002570
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002571 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2572 bind ipv6@:80
2573 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2574 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2575
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002576 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002577 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002578
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002579 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2580 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2581 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2582 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2583 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2584
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002585 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002586 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587
2588
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002589bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002590 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2592 yes | yes | yes | yes
2593 Arguments :
2594 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2595 may be used to override a default value.
2596
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002597 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002598 option may be combined with other numbers.
2599
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002600 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002601 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2602 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2603 missing from all processes.
2604
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002605 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002606 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002607 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2608 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2609 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2610 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2611 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002612 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002613
2614 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2615 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2616 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2617 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2618 and 'even' instances.
2619
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002620 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2621 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2622 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2623 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002624
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002625 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2626 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2627
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002628 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2629 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2630 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2631
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002632 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2633 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2634
2635 Example :
2636 listen app_ip1
2637 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002638 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002639
2640 listen app_ip2
2641 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002642 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002643
2644 listen management
2645 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002646 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002647
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002648 listen management
2649 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2650 bind-process 1-4
2651
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002652 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002653
2654
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002655block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002656 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2658 no | yes | yes | yes
2659
2660 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2661 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002662 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002663 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002664 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002665 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2666 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2667 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002668
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002669 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2670 "http-request deny" instead.
2671
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002672 Example:
2673 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2674 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2675 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002676 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2677 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2678 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002679
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002680 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2681 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2682 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002683
2684capture cookie <name> len <length>
2685 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2687 no | yes | yes | no
2688 Arguments :
2689 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2690 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2691 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2692 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2693 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2694
2695 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2696 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2697 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2698 right if it exceeds <length>.
2699
2700 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2701 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2702 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2703 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2704
2705 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2706 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2707 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2708
2709 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2710 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2711 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002712 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2713 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2714 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715
2716 Example:
2717 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2718
2719 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002720 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002721
2722
2723capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002724 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2726 no | yes | yes | no
2727 Arguments :
2728 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002729 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2731 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2732 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2733
2734 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2735 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2736 it exceeds <length>.
2737
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002738 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002739 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2740 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002741 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2742 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2743 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2744 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002745 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002746 environments to find where the request came from.
2747
2748 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2749 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2750 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2751 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002752
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002753 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2754 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2755 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2756 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2757 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002758
2759 Example:
2760 capture request header Host len 15
2761 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002762 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002764 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002765 about logging.
2766
2767
2768capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002769 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2771 no | yes | yes | no
2772 Arguments :
2773 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002774 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2776 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2777 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2778
2779 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2780 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2781 it exceeds <length>.
2782
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002783 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002784 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2785 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2786 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002787 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2788 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2789 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2790 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002791
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002792 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2793 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2794 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2795 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2796 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002797
2798 Example:
2799 capture response header Content-length len 9
2800 capture response header Location len 15
2801
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002802 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002803 about logging.
2804
2805
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002806clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002807 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2809 yes | yes | yes | no
2810 Arguments :
2811 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2812 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2813 as explained at the top of this document.
2814
2815 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2816 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2817 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2818 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2819 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2820 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2821 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2822 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002823 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002824 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2825 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2826
2827 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2828 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2829 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2830 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2831 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2832 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2833
2834 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2835 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2836
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002837 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2838 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002839
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002840compression algo <algorithm> ...
2841compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002842compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002843 Enable HTTP compression.
2844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2845 yes | yes | yes | yes
2846 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002847 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2848 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2849 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2850
2851 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002852 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2853 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2854 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002855
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002856 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002857 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002858
2859 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2860 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2861 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2862 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2863 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002864 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002865
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002866 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2867 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2868 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2869 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2870 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2871 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2872 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002873 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002874
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002875 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002876 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002877 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2878 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2879 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2880 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2881 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002882
2883 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2884 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2885 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2886 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2887 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002888 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2889 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2890 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2891 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2892 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002893 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2894 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002895
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002896 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002897 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2898 "Accept-Encoding" header
2899 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002900 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002901 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2902 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002903 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2904 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2905 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2906 "multipart"
2907 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2908 header
2909 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2910 and later
2911 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2912 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002913
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002914 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2915 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002916
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002917 Examples :
2918 compression algo gzip
2919 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002920
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002921
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002922contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002923 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2925 yes | no | yes | yes
2926 Arguments :
2927 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2928 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2929 as explained at the top of this document.
2930
2931 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002932 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002933 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002934 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2935 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2936 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2937 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2938
2939 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2940 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2941 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2942 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2943 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2944 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2945
2946 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2947 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2948 instead.
2949
2950 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2951 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2952
2953
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002954cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002955 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2956 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002957 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002958 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2960 yes | no | yes | yes
2961 Arguments :
2962 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2963 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2964 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2965 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2966 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2967 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2968 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2969 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2970 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2971
2972 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2973 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2974 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2975 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2976 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2977 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002978 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2979 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2980 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2981 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2982 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002983
2984 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002985 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002986
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002987 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002988 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2989 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2990 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2991 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2992 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2993 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2994 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2995 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2996 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2997 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002998
2999 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3000 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3001 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3002 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3003 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3004 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3005 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3006 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3007 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003008 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003009 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3010 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3011 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003012
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003013 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3014 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3015 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003016 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3017 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3018 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3019 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003020 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3021 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3022 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023
3024 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3025 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3026 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3027 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3028 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3029 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3030 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3031 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3032 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3033
3034 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3035 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3036 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3037 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3038 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3039 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3040 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3041 persistence cookie in the cache.
3042 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3043
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003044 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3045 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3046 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3047 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3048 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
3049 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
3050 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3051 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3052 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3053 they logout.
3054
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003055 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3056 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3057 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3058 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3059
3060 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3061 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3062 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3063 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3064 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3065 this attribute.
3066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003067 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003068 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003069 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3070 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3071 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3072 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3073 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3074 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003075
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003076 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3077 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3078 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3079 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3080 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3081 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3082 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3083 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3084 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
3085 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3086 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3087 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3088 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3089 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3090 the site.
3091
3092 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3093 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3094 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3095 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3096 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3097 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3098 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3099 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3100 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3101 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3102 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3103 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3104 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3105 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3106 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3107 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3108
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003109 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3110 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3111 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3112 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3113 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3114 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3117 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3118 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3119 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003121 Examples :
3122 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3123 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3124 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003125 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003126
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003127 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003129
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003130declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3131 Declares a capture slot.
3132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3133 no | yes | yes | no
3134 Arguments:
3135 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3136
3137 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3138 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3139 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3140 for use in the response.
3141
3142 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003143 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003144 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3145
3146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003147default-server [param*]
3148 Change default options for a server in a backend
3149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3150 yes | no | yes | yes
3151 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003152 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3153 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3154 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3155 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003156
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003157 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003158 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3159
3160 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003162
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003163default_backend <backend>
3164 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3166 yes | yes | yes | no
3167 Arguments :
3168 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3169
3170 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3171 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3172 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3173 will catch all undetermined requests.
3174
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003175 Example :
3176
3177 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3178 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3179 default_backend dynamic
3180
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003181 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003184description <string>
3185 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3187 no | yes | yes | yes
3188 Arguments : string
3189
3190 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3191 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3192 it describes.
3193 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3194
3195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196disabled
3197 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3199 yes | yes | yes | yes
3200 Arguments : none
3201
3202 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3203 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3204 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3205 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3206 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3207 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3208 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3209
3210 See also : "enabled"
3211
3212
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003213dispatch <address>:<port>
3214 Set a default server address
3215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3216 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003217 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003218
3219 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3220 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3221 during start-up.
3222
3223 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3224 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3225 possible with normal servers.
3226
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003227 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003228 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3229 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3230 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3231 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3232
3233 See also : "server"
3234
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003235
3236dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3237 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3239 yes | no | yes | yes
3240 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3241
3242 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3243 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3244 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3245 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3246 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3247 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003248
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003249enabled
3250 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3252 yes | yes | yes | yes
3253 Arguments : none
3254
3255 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3256 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3257
3258 See also : "disabled"
3259
3260
3261errorfile <code> <file>
3262 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3264 yes | yes | yes | yes
3265 Arguments :
3266 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003267 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3268 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003269
3270 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003271 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003272 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003273 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3274 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275
3276 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3277 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3278 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3279
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003280 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3281
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003282 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3283 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3284 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3285 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3286
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003287 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3288 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3289 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3290 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3291 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3292 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3293
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003294 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3295 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3296 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003297 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3299
3300 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3301
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003302 Example :
3303 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003304 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003305 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3306 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3307
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003308
3309errorloc <code> <url>
3310errorloc302 <code> <url>
3311 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3313 yes | yes | yes | yes
3314 Arguments :
3315 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003316 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3317 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003318
3319 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3320 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3321 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3322 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3323 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3324
3325 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3326 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3327 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3328
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003329 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3330
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003331 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3332 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3333 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3334 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003335 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003336 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3337 request.
3338
3339 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3340
3341
3342errorloc303 <code> <url>
3343 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3345 yes | yes | yes | yes
3346 Arguments :
3347 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003348 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3349 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003350
3351 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3352 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3353 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3354 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3355 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3356
3357 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3358 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3359 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3360
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003361 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3362
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003363 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3364 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3365 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3366 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003367 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003368
3369 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3370
3371
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003372email-alert from <emailaddr>
3373 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3374 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3376 yes | yes | yes | yes
3377
3378 Arguments :
3379
3380 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3381
3382 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3383 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3384
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003385 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003386 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3387 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003388
3389
3390email-alert level <level>
3391 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3392 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3393 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3394 yes | yes | yes | yes
3395
3396 Arguments :
3397
3398 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3399 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3400 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3401
3402 By default level is alert
3403
3404 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3405 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3406 for the proxy.
3407
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003408 Alerts are sent when :
3409
3410 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3411 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3412 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3413 is notice or lower
3414 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3415 and a health check status update occurs
3416
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003417 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3418 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003419 section 3.6 about mailers.
3420
3421
3422email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3423 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3424 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3425 yes | yes | yes | yes
3426
3427 Arguments :
3428
3429 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3430
3431 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3432 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3433
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003434 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3435 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003436
3437
3438email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3439 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3440 mailers.
3441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3442 yes | yes | yes | yes
3443
3444 Arguments :
3445
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003446 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003447
3448 By default the systems hostname is used.
3449
3450 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3451 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3452 for the proxy.
3453
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003454 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3455 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003456
3457
3458email-alert to <emailaddr>
3459 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3460 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3461 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3462 yes | yes | yes | yes
3463
3464 Arguments :
3465
3466 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3467
3468 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3469 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3470
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003471 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003472 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3473
3474
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003475force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3476 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3478 no | yes | yes | yes
3479
3480 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3481 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3482 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3483 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3484 marked down for maintenance operations.
3485
3486 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3487 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3488 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3489 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3490 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3491 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3492 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3493 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3494 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3495
3496 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3497 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3498 is used.
3499
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003500 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003501 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003502
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003503
3504filter <name> [param*]
3505 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3507 no | yes | yes | yes
3508 Arguments :
3509 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3510 referenced in section 9.
3511
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003512 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003513 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003514 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3515 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003516
3517 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3518 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3519
3520 Example:
3521 listen
3522 bind *:80
3523
3524 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3525 filter compression
3526 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3527
3528 compression algo gzip
3529 compression offload
3530
3531 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3532
3533 See also : section 9.
3534
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003535
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003536fullconn <conns>
3537 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3539 yes | no | yes | yes
3540 Arguments :
3541 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3542 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3543
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003544 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003545 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003546 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003547 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3548 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3549 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3550 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3551 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003552 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003553
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003554 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3555 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003556 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3557 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3558 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003559
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003560 Example :
3561 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3562 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3563 # connections.
3564 backend dynamic
3565 fullconn 10000
3566 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3567 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3568
3569 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3570
3571
3572grace <time>
3573 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003575 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003576 Arguments :
3577 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3578 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3579 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3580
3581 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3582 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003583 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003584 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3585
3586 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3587 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3588 simplify it.
3589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003591hash-balance-factor <factor>
3592 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3594 yes | no | no | yes
3595 Arguments :
3596 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3597 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3598 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3599
3600 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3601 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3602 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3603 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3604 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3605 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3606 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3607
3608 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3609 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3610 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3611 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3612 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3613
3614 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3615
3616
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003617hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003618 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3620 yes | no | yes | yes
3621 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003622 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3623 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003624
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003625 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3626 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3627 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3628 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3629 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3630 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3631 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3632 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3633 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3634 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003635
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003636 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3637 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3638 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3639 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3640 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3641 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3642 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3643 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3644 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3645 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3646 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3647 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3648 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003649 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3650 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003651
3652 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3653
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003654 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003655 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3656 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3657 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003658 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3659 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3660 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003661
3662 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3663 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003664 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3665 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3666 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3667 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3668
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003669 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3670 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3671 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3672 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3673 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3674 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3675 parameter.
3676
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003677 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3678 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3679 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3680 used on strings.
3681
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003682 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3683
3684 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3685 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3686 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3687 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3688 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3689 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3690 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3691 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3692 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3693 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3694 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3695 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003696
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003697 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3698 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3699 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003700
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003701 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003702
3703
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003704http-check disable-on-404
3705 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003707 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708 Arguments : none
3709
3710 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3711 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3712 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3713 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3714 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3715 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3716 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3717 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003718 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3719 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3720 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3721
3722 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3723
3724
3725http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003726 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003728 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003729 Arguments :
3730 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3731 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003732 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003733 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3734 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3735 details on the supported keywords.
3736
3737 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3738 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3739 with the usual backslash ('\').
3740
3741 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3742 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3743 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3744 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3745 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3746
3747 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003748 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003749 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3750 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3751 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3752
3753 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003754 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003755 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3756 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3757 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3758 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3759
3760 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003761 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003762 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3763 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3764 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3765 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3766 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3767 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3768 trace).
3769
3770 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003771 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003772 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3773 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3774 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3775 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3776 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3777 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3778
3779 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3780 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3781 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3782 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3783 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3784 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3785 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3786 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3787
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003788 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3789 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3790 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3791
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003792 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3793 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3794
3795 Examples :
3796 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003797 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003798
3799 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003800 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003801
3802 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003803 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003804
3805 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003806 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003807
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003808 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003809
3810
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003811http-check send-state
3812 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3814 yes | no | yes | yes
3815 Arguments : none
3816
3817 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3818 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3819 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3820 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3821 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3822
3823 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3824 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3825 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3826 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3827 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003828 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3829 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3830 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3831
3832 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3833 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3834 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3835
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003836 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3837 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3838 checked in multiple backends.
3839
3840 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3841 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3842
3843 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3844 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3845 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3846 one fails.
3847
3848 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3849 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3850 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3851
3852 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3853 server's queue.
3854
3855 Example of a header received by the application server :
3856 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3857 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3858
3859 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3860
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003861http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> | reject |
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003862 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003863 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003864 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003865 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003866 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3867 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003868 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3869 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003870 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3871 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3872 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003873 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003874 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003875 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003876 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003877 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003878 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003879 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02003880 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003881 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003882 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003883 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3884
3885 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3886 no | yes | yes | yes
3887
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003888 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3889 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3890 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3891 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3892 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003893
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003894 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3895 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3896 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3897
3898 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003899 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3900 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3901 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3902 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003903
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01003904 - "reject" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes
3905 the connection without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
3906 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an
3907 immediate connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
3908
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003909 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3910 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3911 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003912 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3913 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003914 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3915 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3916 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3917 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3918 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003919 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003920 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3921 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003922
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003923 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3924 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3925 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3926 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3927 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3928
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003929 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3930 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3931 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003932 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3933 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003934
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003935 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3936 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3937 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3938 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3939 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3940 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3941 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3942 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3943
3944 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3945 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3946 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003947 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3948 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003949
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003950 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3951 <name>.
3952
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003953 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3954 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3955 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3956 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3957 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3958 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3959 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3960 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3961
3962 Example:
3963
3964 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3965
3966 applied to:
3967
3968 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3969
3970 outputs:
3971
3972 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3973
3974 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3975
3976 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3977 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3978 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3979 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3980 header.
3981
3982 Example:
3983
3984 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3985
3986 applied to:
3987
3988 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3989
3990 outputs:
3991
3992 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3993
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003994 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3995 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3996 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3997 it.
3998
3999 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
4000 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
4001 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
4002 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
4003 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
4004 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4005
4006 Example :
4007 # prepend the host name before the path
4008 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
4009
4010 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
4011 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
4012 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
4013 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
4014 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
4015 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
4016 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
4017 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
4018
4019 Example :
4020 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4021 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
4022
4023 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
4024 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
4025 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
4026 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
4027 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
4028 "set-query".
4029
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004030 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4031 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4032 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4033 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4034 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4035 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4036 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4037 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4038
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004039 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4040 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4041 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4042 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4043 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4044 another equipment.
4045
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004046 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4047 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4048 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4049 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4050 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4051 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4052 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4053 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4054
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004055 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4056 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4057 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4058 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4059 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4060 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4061 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4062 admin privileges.
4063
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004064 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4065 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4066 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4067 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4068 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4069 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4070 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4071 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4072
4073 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4074 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4075 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4076 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4077 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4078 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4079
4080 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4081 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4082 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4083 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4084 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4085 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4086
4087 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4088 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4089 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4090 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4091 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4092 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4093 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4094 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4095 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4096
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004097 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004098 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4099 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4100 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4101 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4102 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4103 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4104 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4105 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4106 request header" for more information.
4107
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004108 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4109 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4110 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4111 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004112 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4113 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004114
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004115 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4116 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4117 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4118 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4119 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4120 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4121 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4122 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4123 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4124 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4125 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4126 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4127
4128 These actions take one or two arguments :
4129 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4130 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4131 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4132 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4133
4134 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4135 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4136 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4137 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4138
4139 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4140 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4141 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4142 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4143 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4144 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4145 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4146 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4147
4148 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4149 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4150 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4151 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4152 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4153
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004154 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4155 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4156 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4157 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4158 continues.
4159
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004160 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4161 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4162 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4163 the actions evaluation continues.
4164
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004165 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4166 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4167 inline.
4168
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004169 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4170 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004171 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004172 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4173 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004174 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004175 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004176 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004177 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4178 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004179 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004180 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004181 and '_'.
4182
4183 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4184 followed by some converters.
4185
4186 Example:
4187
4188 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4189
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004190 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4191 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4192
4193 Example:
4194
4195 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4196
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004197 - set-src <expr> :
4198 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4199 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4200 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4201 source IP for privacy.
4202
4203 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4204 followed by some converters.
4205
4206 Example:
4207
4208 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4209 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4210
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004211 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4212 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004213
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004214 - set-src-port <expr> :
4215 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4216 expression.
4217
4218 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4219 followed by some converters.
4220
4221 Example:
4222
4223 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4224 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4225
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004226 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4227 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4228 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004229
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004230 - set-dst <expr> :
4231 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4232 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4233 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4234 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4235 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4236
4237 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4238 followed by some converters.
4239
4240 Example:
4241
4242 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4243 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4244
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004245 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4246 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4247
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004248 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4249 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4250 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4251 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4252
4253 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4254 followed by some converters.
4255
4256 Example:
4257
4258 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4259 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4260
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004261 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4262 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4263 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4264
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004265 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4266 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4267 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4268 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4269 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4270 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4271 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4272 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4273 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4274 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4275 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4276 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4277 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4278 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4279 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4280 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4281
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004282
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004283 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4284 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4285 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4286
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004287 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4288 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4289 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4290 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4291 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4292 SPOE agent name must be used.
4293
4294 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4295
4296 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4297 configuration.
4298
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004299 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4300
4301 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4302 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004303 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4304 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4305
4306 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4307 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4308 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4309 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004310
4311 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004312 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4313 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4314 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004315
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004316 http-request allow if nagios
4317 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4318 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4319 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004320
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004321 Example:
4322 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004323 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004324
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004325 Example:
4326 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4327 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004328 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004329 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4330 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4331 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4332 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4333 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4334 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4335
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004336 Example:
4337 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4338 acl add path /addacl
4339 acl del path /delacl
4340
4341 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4342
4343 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4344 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4345
4346 Example:
4347 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4348 acl setmap path /setmap
4349 acl delmap path /delmap
4350
4351 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4352
4353 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4354 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4355
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004356 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4357 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004358
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004359http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004360 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004361 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004362 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4363 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004364 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004365 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4366 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4367 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4368 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004369 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004370 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004371 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004372 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004373 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004374 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004375 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004376 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004377 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004378 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004379 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4380
4381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4382 no | yes | yes | yes
4383
4384 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4385 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4386 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4387 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4388 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4389 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4390
4391 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4392 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4393 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4394 current section.
4395
4396 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4397 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4398 rules are evaluated.
4399
4400 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4401 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4402 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4403 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4404 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4405 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4406 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4407
4408 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4409 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4410 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4411 external users.
4412
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004413 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4414 <name>.
4415
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004416 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4417 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4418 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4419 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4420 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4421 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4422 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4423 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4424
4425 Example:
4426
4427 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4428
4429 applied to:
4430
4431 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4432
4433 outputs:
4434
4435 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4436
4437 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4438
4439 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4440 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4441 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4442 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4443 header.
4444
4445 Example:
4446
4447 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4448
4449 applied to:
4450
4451 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4452
4453 outputs:
4454
4455 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4456
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004457 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004458 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4459 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4460 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004461
4462 Example:
4463
4464 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4465 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004466 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4467 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004468
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004469 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4470 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4471 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4472 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4473 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4474 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4475 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4476 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4477
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004478 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4479 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4480 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4481 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4482 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4483 another equipment.
4484
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004485 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4486 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4487 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4488 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4489 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4490 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4491 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4492 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4493
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004494 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4495 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4496 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4497 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4498 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4499 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4500 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4501 admin privileges.
4502
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004503 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4504 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4505 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4506 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4507 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4508 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4509 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4510 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4511
4512 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4513 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4514 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4515 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4516 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4517 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4518
4519 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4520 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4521 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4522 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4523 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4524 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4525
4526 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4527 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4528 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4529 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4530 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4531 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4532 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4533 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4534 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4535
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004536 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4537 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4538 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4539 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4540 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4541 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4542 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4543 response header" for more information.
4544
4545 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4546 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4547 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4548 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4549 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004550 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4551 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004552
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004553 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4554 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4555 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4556 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4557 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4558 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4559
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004560 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4561 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4562 inline.
4563
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004564 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4565 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004566 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004567 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4568 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004569 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004570 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004571 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004572 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4573 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004574 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004575 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4576 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004577
4578 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4579 followed by some converters.
4580
4581 Example:
4582
4583 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4584
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004585 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4586 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4587
4588 Example:
4589
4590 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4591
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004592 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4593 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4594 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4595 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4596 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4597 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4598 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4599
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004600 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4601 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4602 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4603 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4604 continues.
4605
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004606 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4607 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4608 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4609 the actions evaluation continues.
4610
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004611 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4612 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4613 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4614 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4615 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4616 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4617 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4618 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4619 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4620 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4621 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4622 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4623 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4624 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4625 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4626 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4627
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004628 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4629 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4630 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4631 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4632 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4633 SPOE agent name must be used.
4634
4635 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4636
4637 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4638 configuration.
4639
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004640 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4641
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004642 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004643 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4644 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004645 rules.
4646
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004647 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4648 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4649 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4650 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4651
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004652 Example:
4653 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4654
4655 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4656
4657 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4658 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4659
4660 Example:
4661 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4662
4663 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4664
4665 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4666 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4667
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004668 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4669 ACL usage.
4670
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004671
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004672http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4673 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4674
4675 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 yes | no | yes | yes
4677
4678 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4679 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4680 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4681 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4682 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4683 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4684
4685 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4686
4687 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4688 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4689 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4690 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4691 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4692 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4693 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4694 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4695 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4696 not checking any request past the first one.
4697
4698 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4699 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4700 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4701 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4702 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4703 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4704 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4705
4706 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4707 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4708 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4709 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4710 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4711 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4712 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4713 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4714 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4715 downsides of rare connection failures.
4716
4717 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4718 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4719 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4720 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4721 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4722 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4723 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4724 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4725 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4726 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4727 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4728 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4729
4730 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4731 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4732 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4733 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4734
4735 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4736 and are never shared ;
4737
4738 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4739 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4740 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4741 and are never shared ;
4742
4743 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4744 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4745 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4746
4747 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4748 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4749 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4750
4751 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4752
4753
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004754http-send-name-header [<header>]
4755 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4756
4757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | no | yes | yes
4759
4760 Arguments :
4761
4762 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4763
4764 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4765 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4766 is added with the header string proved.
4767
4768 See also : "server"
4769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004770id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004771 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4773 no | yes | yes | yes
4774 Arguments : none
4775
4776 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4777 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4778 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004779
4780
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004781ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4782 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4783 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4784 no | yes | yes | yes
4785
4786 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4787 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4788 and running).
4789
4790 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4791 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4792 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004793 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004794 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4795
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004796 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4797 "unless" condition is met.
4798
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004799 Example:
4800 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4801 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4802 ignore-persist if url_static
4803
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004804 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4805
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004806load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4807 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4808 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | no | yes | yes
4810
4811 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4812 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4813 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4814 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4815 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4816 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4817 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4818 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4819
4820 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4821 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004822 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004823
4824 Arguments:
4825 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4826 named "server-state-file".
4827
4828 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4829 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4830 name is used as a file name.
4831
4832 none don't load any stat for this backend
4833
4834 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004835 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4836 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4837 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4838 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4839 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004840
4841 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4842 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4843
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004844 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004845
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004846 global
4847 stats socket /tmp/socket
4848 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004849
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004850 defaults
4851 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004852
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004853 backend bk
4854 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4855 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004856
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004857
4858 Then one can run :
4859
4860 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4861
4862 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4863
4864 1
4865 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4866 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4867 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4868
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004869 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004870
4871 global
4872 stats socket /tmp/socket
4873 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4874
4875 defaults
4876 load-server-state-from-file local
4877
4878 backend bk
4879 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4880 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4881
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004882
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004883 Then one can run :
4884
4885 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4886
4887 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4888
4889 1
4890 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4891 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4892 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4893
4894 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4895 "show servers state"
4896
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004897
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004898log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004899log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004900no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004901 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4903 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004904
4905 Prefix :
4906 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4907 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4908 prefix does not allow arguments.
4909
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910 Arguments :
4911 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4912 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4913 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4914 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4915 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4916 parameter.
4917
4918 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4919 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4920
4921 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4922 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4923 standard syslog port).
4924
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004925 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4926 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4927 standard syslog port).
4928
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004929 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4930 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4931 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4932 appropriately writeable).
4933
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004934 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4935 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004936
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004937 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4938 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4939 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4940 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4941 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4942 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4943 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4944 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4945 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4946 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4947 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4948
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004949 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4950
4951 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4952 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4953 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4954
4955 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4956 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4957 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004958 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4959 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4960 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4961 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4962 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004963
4964 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4965
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004966 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4967 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4968 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004969
4970 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4971 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4972 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4973 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4974
4975 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4976 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004977
4978 Example :
4979 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004980 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4981 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004982 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004983
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004984
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004985log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004986 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4988 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004989
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004990 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4991 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4992 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4993 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4994 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004995
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004996 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4997 "option httplog" directives.
4998
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004999log-format-sd <string>
5000 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5002 yes | yes | yes | no
5003
5004 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5005 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5006 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5007 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5008 which covers the log format string in depth.
5009
5010 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5011 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5012
5013 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5014 log format to "rfc5424".
5015
5016 Example :
5017 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5018
5019
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005020log-tag <string>
5021 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 yes | yes | yes | yes
5024
5025 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5026 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5027 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5028 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5029 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5030 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5031 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5032 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5033 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005034
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005035max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5036 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5038 yes | no | yes | yes
5039
5040 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5041 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5042 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5043 servers.
5044
5045 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5046 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5047 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5048 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5049 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
5050 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
5051 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5052 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5053 picking a different server.
5054
5055 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5056 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5057 even if they have to be queued.
5058
5059 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5060 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5061
5062
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005063maxconn <conns>
5064 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5066 yes | yes | yes | no
5067 Arguments :
5068 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5069 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5070 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5071 closes.
5072
5073 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5074 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5075 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5076 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005077 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5078 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5079 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5080 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005081
5082 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5083 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5084 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5085
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005086 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5087
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005088 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5089
5090
5091mode { tcp|http|health }
5092 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5094 yes | yes | yes | yes
5095 Arguments :
5096 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5097 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5098 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5099 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5100
5101 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5102 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5103 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5104 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5105 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5106
5107 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005108 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5109 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5110 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5111 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5112 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5113 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5114 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005115
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005116 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5117 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5118 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005119
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005120 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005121 defaults http_instances
5122 mode http
5123
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005124 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005125
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005126
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005127monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005128 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5130 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005131 Arguments :
5132 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5133 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005134 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005135 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5136 backend and its backup.
5137
5138 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5139 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5140 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5141 servers in a list of backends.
5142
5143 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5144 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5145 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5146 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5147 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5148 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5149 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005150 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5151 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005152
5153 Example:
5154 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005155 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005156 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5157 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5158 monitor-uri /site_alive
5159 monitor fail if site_dead
5160
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005161 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005162
5163
5164monitor-net <source>
5165 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5167 yes | yes | yes | no
5168 Arguments :
5169 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5170 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5171 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5172 followed by a mask.
5173
5174 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5175 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005176 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005177 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5178
5179 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5180 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5181 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5182 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005183 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5184 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5185 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005186
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005187 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5188 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5189 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5190 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5191 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5192 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005193
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005194 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5195 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005196
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005197 Example :
5198 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5199 frontend www
5200 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5201
5202 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5203
5204
5205monitor-uri <uri>
5206 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5208 yes | yes | yes | no
5209 Arguments :
5210 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5211 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5212
5213 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5214 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5215 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5216 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5217 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5218 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5219 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5220 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5221
5222 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5223 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5224 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5225 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5226 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5227 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5228
5229 Example :
5230 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5231 frontend www
5232 mode http
5233 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5234
5235 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5236
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005237
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005238option abortonclose
5239no option abortonclose
5240 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5242 yes | no | yes | yes
5243 Arguments : none
5244
5245 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5246 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5247 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5248 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005249 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005250 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5251 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5252 encountered while delivering the response.
5253
5254 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5255 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5256 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5257 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5258 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5259 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005260 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005261 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005262 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005263 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5264 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5265 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5266
5267 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5268 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5269 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5270 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5271 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5272 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5273 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5274 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005275 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005276
5277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5279
5280 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5281
5282
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005283option accept-invalid-http-request
5284no option accept-invalid-http-request
5285 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5287 yes | yes | yes | no
5288 Arguments : none
5289
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005290 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005291 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5292 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5293 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5294 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5295 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5296 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5297 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005298 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5299 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5300 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5301 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5302 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005303 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005304 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5305 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5306 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005307
5308 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5309 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5310 been confirmed.
5311
5312 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5313 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005314 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5315 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005316 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5317
5318 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5319 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5320
5321 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5322 stats socket.
5323
5324
5325option accept-invalid-http-response
5326no option accept-invalid-http-response
5327 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5329 yes | no | yes | yes
5330 Arguments : none
5331
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005332 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005333 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5334 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5335 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5336 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5337 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5338 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5339 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005340 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5341 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5342 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005343
5344 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5345 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5346 been confirmed.
5347
5348 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5349 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5350 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5351 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5352
5353 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5354 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5355
5356 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5357 stats socket.
5358
5359
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005360option allbackups
5361no option allbackups
5362 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5364 yes | no | yes | yes
5365 Arguments : none
5366
5367 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5368 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5369 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5370 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5371 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5372 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5373 order between the backup servers anymore.
5374
5375 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5376 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5377
5378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5380
5381
5382option checkcache
5383no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005384 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5386 yes | no | yes | yes
5387 Arguments : none
5388
5389 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5390 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005391 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005392 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5393 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005394 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005395
5396 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005397 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005398 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005399 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5400 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005401 to the client are :
5402 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005403 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005404 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005405 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5406 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5407 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5408 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5409 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5410 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5411 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5412 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5413 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5414 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5415 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5416
5417 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005418 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005419 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005420 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005421 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5422
5423 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5424 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005425 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005426 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5427
5428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5430
5431
5432option clitcpka
5433no option clitcpka
5434 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5436 yes | yes | yes | no
5437 Arguments : none
5438
5439 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5440 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5441 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5442 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5443
5444 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5445 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5446 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5447 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5448
5449 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5450 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5451 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5452 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5453 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5454
5455 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5456
5457 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5458 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5459 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5460
5461 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5462 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5463
5464 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5465
5466
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005467option contstats
5468 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5470 yes | yes | yes | no
5471 Arguments : none
5472
5473 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5474 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5475 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5476 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005477 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5478 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5479 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5480 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5481 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005482
5483
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005484option dontlog-normal
5485no option dontlog-normal
5486 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5488 yes | yes | yes | no
5489 Arguments : none
5490
5491 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5492 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5493 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5494 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5495 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5496 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5497 logged.
5498
5499 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5500 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5501 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005503 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005504 logging.
5505
5506
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005507option dontlognull
5508no option dontlognull
5509 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5511 yes | yes | yes | no
5512 Arguments : none
5513
5514 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5515 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5516 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5517 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5518 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5519 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005520 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5521 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5522 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005523
5524 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5525 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5526 would not be logged.
5527
5528 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5529 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5530
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005531 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5532 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005533
5534
5535option forceclose
5536no option forceclose
5537 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005539 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005540 Arguments : none
5541
5542 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5543 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5544 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5545 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5546 global session times in the logs.
5547
5548 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005549 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005550 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005551
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005552 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5553 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5554 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5555
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005556 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5557 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005558
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005559 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5560 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5561
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005562 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005563
5564
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005565option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005566 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5568 yes | yes | yes | yes
5569 Arguments :
5570 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5571 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005572 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005573 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005574
5575 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5576 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5577 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5578 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5579 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5580 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5581 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005582 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5583 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5584 possible that the client has already brought one.
5585
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005586 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005587 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005588 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5589 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005590 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5591 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005592
5593 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5594 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5595 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5596 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5597 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5598 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5599 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5600
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005601 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5602 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5603 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5604 are under the control of the end-user.
5605
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005606 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005607 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5608 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005609 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5610 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5611 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005612
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005613 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005614 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5615 frontend www
5616 mode http
5617 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5618
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005619 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5620 backend www
5621 mode http
5622 option forwardfor header X-Client
5623
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005624 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005625 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005626
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005627
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005628option http-buffer-request
5629no option http-buffer-request
5630 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5632 yes | yes | yes | yes
5633 Arguments : none
5634
5635 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5636 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5637 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5638 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5639 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5640 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5641 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5642 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005643 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005644 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5645 default.
5646
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005647 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005648
5649
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005650option http-ignore-probes
5651no option http-ignore-probes
5652 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5654 yes | yes | yes | no
5655 Arguments : none
5656
5657 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5658 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5659 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5660 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5661 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5662 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5663 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5664 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5665 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5666 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5667 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5668 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5669
5670 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5671 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5672 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5673 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5674 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5675 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5676 are often the only way to detect them.
5677
5678 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5679 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5680
5681 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5682
5683
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005684option http-keep-alive
5685no option http-keep-alive
5686 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5688 yes | yes | yes | yes
5689 Arguments : none
5690
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005691 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5692 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5693 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5694 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5695 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5696 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5697 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5698
5699 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5700 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005701 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5702 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5703 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5704 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5705 situations where this option may be useful :
5706
5707 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5708 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5709
5710 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5711 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5712
5713 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5714 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5715 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5716 request.
5717
5718 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5719 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005720 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5721 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5722 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005723
5724 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5725 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5726
5727 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5728 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5729 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5730 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5731 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5732 not set.
5733
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005734 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5735 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005736 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005737 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005738
5739 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005740 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5741 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005742
5743
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005744option http-no-delay
5745no option http-no-delay
5746 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5748 yes | yes | yes | yes
5749 Arguments : none
5750
5751 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5752 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5753 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5754 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5755 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5756 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5757 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5758 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5759 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5760 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5761 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5762 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5763 affected.
5764
5765 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5766 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5767 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5768 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5769 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5770 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5771 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5772 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5773 latency environments.
5774
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005775 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5776
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005777
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005778option http-pretend-keepalive
5779no option http-pretend-keepalive
5780 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5782 yes | yes | yes | yes
5783 Arguments : none
5784
5785 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5786 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5787 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5788 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5789 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5790 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5791 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5792 consider the response complete.
5793
5794 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5795 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5796 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5797 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5798 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5799 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5800
5801 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5802 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5803 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5804 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5805 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5806 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5807 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5808
5809 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5810 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005811 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005812 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5813 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005814
5815 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5816 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5817
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005818 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5819 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005820
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005821
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005822option http-server-close
5823no option http-server-close
5824 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5826 yes | yes | yes | yes
5827 Arguments : none
5828
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005829 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5830 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5831 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5832 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5833 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5834 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5835 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5836 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5837 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5838 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5839 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005840 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005841 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5842 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5843 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5844 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005845
5846 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5847 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5848 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5849 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005850 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5851 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005852
5853 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5854 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005855 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5856 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005857 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5858 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005859
5860 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5861 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5862
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005863 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005864 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5865 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005866
5867
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005868option http-tunnel
5869no option http-tunnel
5870 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 yes | yes | yes | yes
5873 Arguments : none
5874
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005875 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5876 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5877 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5878 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5879 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5880 "option http-tunnel".
5881
5882 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005883 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005884 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5885 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5886 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5887 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5888 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5889 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5890 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005891
5892 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5893 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5894
5895 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5896 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5897 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5898
5899
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005900option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005901no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005902 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5904 yes | yes | yes | no
5905 Arguments : none
5906
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005907 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005908 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5909 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5910 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5911 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5912 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5913 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5914
5915 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5916 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005917 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5918 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5919 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005920
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005921 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5922 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5923 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5924 front of an existing proxy.
5925
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005926 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5927
5928 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5929 http-server-close".
5930
5931
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005932option httpchk
5933option httpchk <uri>
5934option httpchk <method> <uri>
5935option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5936 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5938 yes | no | yes | yes
5939 Arguments :
5940 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5941 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5942 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5943 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5944 ones.
5945
5946 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5947 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5948 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5949
5950 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5951 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5952 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5953 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5954 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5955
5956 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5957 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5958 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5959 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5960 the lack of any response.
5961
5962 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5963
5964 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5965 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5966 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5967
5968 Examples :
5969 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5970 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5971 backend https_relay
5972 mode tcp
5973 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5974 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5975
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005976 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5977 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5978 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005979
5980
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005981option httpclose
5982no option httpclose
5983 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5985 yes | yes | yes | yes
5986 Arguments : none
5987
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005988 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5989 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5990 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5991 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005992 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005993 "option http-tunnel".
5994
5995 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5996 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5997 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5998 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5999 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
6000 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
6001 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
6002 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006003
6004 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006005 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01006006 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
6007 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
6008 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
6009 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
6010 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006011
6012 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6013 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006014 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
6015 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006016 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
6017 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006018
6019 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6020 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6021
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02006022 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
6023 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006024
6025
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006026option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006027 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6029 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006030 Arguments :
6031 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6032 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6033 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
6034 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
6035 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006036
6037 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6038 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6039 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6040 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6041 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6042 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6043 ports.
6044
6045 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6046
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006047 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6048 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006049
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006050 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6051
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006052 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006053
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006054
6055option http_proxy
6056no option http_proxy
6057 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6058 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6059 yes | yes | yes | yes
6060 Arguments : none
6061
6062 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6063 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6064 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6065 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6066 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6067
6068 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6069 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006070 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6071 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006072
6073 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6074 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6075
6076 Example :
6077 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6078 backend direct_forward
6079 option httpclose
6080 option http_proxy
6081
6082 See also : "option httpclose"
6083
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006084
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006085option independent-streams
6086no option independent-streams
6087 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6089 yes | yes | yes | yes
6090 Arguments : none
6091
6092 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6093 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6094 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6095 receive data or not.
6096
6097 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
6098 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6099 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6100 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6101 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6102 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6103 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6104 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6105 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6106 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6107 socket buffers.
6108
6109 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6110 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6111 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6112 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6113 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6114
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006115 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006116 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6117 deprecated.
6118
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006119 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006120
6121
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006122option ldap-check
6123 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 yes | no | yes | yes
6126 Arguments : none
6127
6128 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6129 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6130 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6131 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6132
6133 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6134 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6135
6136 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6137 configure it.
6138
6139 Example :
6140 option ldap-check
6141
6142 See also : "option httpchk"
6143
6144
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006145option external-check
6146 Use external processes for server health checks
6147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6148 yes | no | yes | yes
6149
6150 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6151 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6152 command".
6153
6154 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6155
6156 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6157
6158
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006159option log-health-checks
6160no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006161 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6163 yes | no | yes | yes
6164 Arguments : none
6165
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006166 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6167 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6168 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006169
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006170 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6171 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6172 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6173 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6174 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6175
6176 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6177 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006178
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006179 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6180 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6181 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006182
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006183
6184option log-separate-errors
6185no option log-separate-errors
6186 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6188 yes | yes | yes | no
6189 Arguments : none
6190
6191 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6192 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6193 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6194 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6195 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6196 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6197 provides very important information.
6198
6199 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6200 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6201 error logs.
6202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006203 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006204 logging.
6205
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006206
6207option logasap
6208no option logasap
6209 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6211 yes | yes | yes | no
6212 Arguments : none
6213
6214 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6215 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6216 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6217 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6218 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6219 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6220 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006221 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006222 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6223 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6224
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006225 Examples :
6226 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6227 mode http
6228 option httplog
6229 option logasap
6230 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6231
6232 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6233 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6234 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6235 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6236
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006237 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006238 logging.
6239
6240
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006241option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006242 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6244 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006245 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006246 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6247 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006248 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006249
6250 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6251 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6252 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6253 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6254 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6255 in the MySQL table, like this :
6256
6257 USE mysql;
6258 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6259 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6260
6261 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6262 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6263 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6264 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6265 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6266 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6267 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6268 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6269 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6270
6271 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6272 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006273
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006274 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006275
6276 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6277 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6278 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6279 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006280 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6281 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006282
6283 See also: "option httpchk"
6284
6285
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006286option nolinger
6287no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006288 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006289 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6290 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006291 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006292
6293 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6294 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6295 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6296 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6297 connections.
6298
6299 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6300 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6301 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6302 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6303 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6304 this too.
6305
6306 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6307 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6308 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6309
6310 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6311 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6312 for servers.
6313
6314 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6315 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6316
6317
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006318option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6319 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6321 yes | yes | yes | yes
6322 Arguments :
6323 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6324 matching <network>
6325 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6326 header name.
6327
6328 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6329 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6330 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6331 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6332 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6333 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6334 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6335 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6336 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6337 possible that the client has already brought one.
6338
6339 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6340 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6341 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6342 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6343 header and requires different one.
6344
6345 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6346 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6347 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6348 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6349 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6350 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6351 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6352
6353 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6354 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6355 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6356 both are defined.
6357
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006358 Examples :
6359 # Original Destination address
6360 frontend www
6361 mode http
6362 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6363
6364 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6365 backend www
6366 mode http
6367 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6368
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006369 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6370 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006371
6372
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006373option persist
6374no option persist
6375 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6376 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6377 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006378 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006379
6380 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6381 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6382 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6383 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6384 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6385 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6386 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6387 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6388 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6389 redirected to another valid server.
6390
6391 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6392 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6393
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006394 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006395
6396
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006397option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6398 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6400 yes | no | yes | yes
6401 Arguments :
6402 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6403 PostgreSQL server.
6404
6405 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6406 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6407 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6408 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6409
6410 See also: "option httpchk"
6411
6412
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006413option prefer-last-server
6414no option prefer-last-server
6415 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6417 yes | no | yes | yes
6418 Arguments : none
6419
6420 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6421 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6422 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6423 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6424 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6425 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6426 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6427 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6428 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006429 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6430 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6431 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6432 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6433 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6434 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6435 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006436
6437 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6438 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6439
6440 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6441
6442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006443option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006444option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006445no option redispatch
6446 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6447 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6448 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006449 Arguments :
6450 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6451 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6452 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6453 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6454 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6455 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6456 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6457 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6458 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6459
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006460
6461 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6462 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6463 be able to access the service anymore.
6464
6465 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6466 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6467
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006468 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006469 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6470 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006472 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6473 "redisp" keywords.
6474
6475 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6476 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6477
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006478 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006479
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006480
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006481option redis-check
6482 Use redis health checks for server testing
6483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6484 yes | no | yes | yes
6485 Arguments : none
6486
6487 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6488 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6489 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6490 find the "+PONG" response message.
6491
6492 Example :
6493 option redis-check
6494
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006495 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006496
6497
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006498option smtpchk
6499option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6500 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006503 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006504 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6505 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6506 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6507
6508 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6509 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6510 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6511
6512 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6513 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6514 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6515 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6516 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6517 dead server.
6518
6519 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6520 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6521 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6522 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6523
6524 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6525 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6526 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6527 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006528 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006529
6530 Example :
6531 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6532
6533 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006536option socket-stats
6537no option socket-stats
6538
6539 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6541 yes | yes | yes | no
6542
6543 Arguments : none
6544
6545
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006546option splice-auto
6547no option splice-auto
6548 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6550 yes | yes | yes | yes
6551 Arguments : none
6552
6553 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6554 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6555 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6556 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006557 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006558 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6559 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6560 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6561 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6562
6563 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6564 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6565 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6566 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6567 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6568 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6569 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6570 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6571 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6572 keyword.
6573
6574 Example :
6575 option splice-auto
6576
6577 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6578 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6579
6580 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6581 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6582
6583
6584option splice-request
6585no option splice-request
6586 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6588 yes | yes | yes | yes
6589 Arguments : none
6590
6591 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006592 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006593 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6594 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6595 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6596 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6597
6598 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6599
6600 Example :
6601 option splice-request
6602
6603 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6604 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6605
6606 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6607 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6608
6609
6610option splice-response
6611no option splice-response
6612 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6614 yes | yes | yes | yes
6615 Arguments : none
6616
6617 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006618 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006619 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6620 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6621 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6622 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6623
6624 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6625
6626 Example :
6627 option splice-response
6628
6629 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6630 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6631
6632 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6633 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6634
6635
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006636option spop-check
6637 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6639 no | no | no | yes
6640 Arguments : none
6641
6642 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6643 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6644 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6645 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6646
6647 Example :
6648 option spop-check
6649
6650 See also : "option httpchk"
6651
6652
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006653option srvtcpka
6654no option srvtcpka
6655 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 yes | no | yes | yes
6658 Arguments : none
6659
6660 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6661 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6662 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6663 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6664
6665 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6666 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6667 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6668 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6669
6670 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6671 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6672 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6673 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6674 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6675
6676 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6677
6678 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6679 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6680 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6681
6682 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6683 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6684
6685 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6686
6687
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006688option ssl-hello-chk
6689 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6691 yes | no | yes | yes
6692 Arguments : none
6693
6694 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6695 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6696 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6697 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6698 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6699 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6700 hello message.
6701
6702 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6703 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6704 messages, which is appreciable.
6705
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006706 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6707 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6708 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006709
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006710 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6711
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006712
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006713option tcp-check
6714 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6716 yes | no | yes | yes
6717
6718 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6719 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6720
6721 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6722 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6723 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6724
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006725 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006726 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6727 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6728 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6729 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6730 only.
6731
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006732 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006733 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6734 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6735 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6736 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6737
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006738 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006739 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6740 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006741 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006742 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6743 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6744 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6745 the respective protocols.
6746 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6747 analysed.
6748
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006749 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6750 script.
6751
6752 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6753 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6754 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6755 The "comment" is of course optional.
6756
6757
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006758 Examples :
6759 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6760 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006761 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006762
6763 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6764 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006765 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006766
6767 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6768 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006769 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006770 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006771 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006772 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006773 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006774 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006775 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6776 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006777 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006778 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6779 tcp-check expect string +OK
6780
6781 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6782 (send many headers before analyzing)
6783 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006784 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006785 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6786 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6787 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6788 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006789 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006790
6791
6792 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6793
6794
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006795option tcp-smart-accept
6796no option tcp-smart-accept
6797 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6799 yes | yes | yes | no
6800 Arguments : none
6801
6802 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6803 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6804 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6805 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6806 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6807 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6808
6809 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6810 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6811 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6812 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6813
6814 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6815 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6816 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6817 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6818
6819 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6820 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6821 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6822
6823 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6824 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6825 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6826
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006827 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6828
6829
6830option tcp-smart-connect
6831no option tcp-smart-connect
6832 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6834 yes | no | yes | yes
6835 Arguments : none
6836
6837 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6838 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6839 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6840 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6841 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6842
6843 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6844 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6845 complex.
6846
6847 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6848 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6849 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6850
6851 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6852 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6853
6854 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6855
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006856
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006857option tcpka
6858 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6860 yes | yes | yes | yes
6861 Arguments : none
6862
6863 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6864 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6865 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6866 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6867
6868 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6869 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6870 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6871 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6872
6873 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6874 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6875 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6876 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6877 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6878
6879 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6880
6881 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6882 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6883 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6884 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6885 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6886 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6887 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6888 backends.
6889
6890 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6891
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006892
6893option tcplog
6894 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6896 yes | yes | yes | yes
6897 Arguments : none
6898
6899 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6900 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6901 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6902 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6903 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6904 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6905 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6906 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6907
6908 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6909
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006910 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006912 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006913
6914
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006915option transparent
6916no option transparent
6917 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6918 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006919 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006920 Arguments : none
6921
6922 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6923 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6924 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6925 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6926 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6927 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6928 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6929 appropriate server.
6930
6931 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6932 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6933
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006934 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006935 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006936
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006937
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006938external-check command <command>
6939 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6941 yes | no | yes | yes
6942
6943 Arguments :
6944 <command> is the external command to run
6945
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006946 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6947
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006948 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006949
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006950 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6951 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6952 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6953 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6954 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6955 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006956
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006957 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6958
6959 Environment variables :
6960 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6961 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6962
6963 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6964
6965 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6966
6967 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6968 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6969 for a UNIX socket).
6970
6971 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6972
6973 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6974
6975 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6976
6977 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6978
6979 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6980
6981 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6982 socket).
6983
6984 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6985 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6986
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006987 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6988 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6989 failed.
6990
6991 Example :
6992 external-check command /bin/true
6993
6994 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6995
6996
6997external-check path <path>
6998 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7000 yes | no | yes | yes
7001
7002 Arguments :
7003 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7004
7005 The default path is "".
7006
7007 Example :
7008 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7009
7010 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7011 "external-check command"
7012
7013
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007014persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007015persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007016 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7018 yes | no | yes | yes
7019 Arguments :
7020 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007021 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7022 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007023
7024 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7025 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
7026 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
7027 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7028 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7029 forwarded to this server.
7030
7031 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7032 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7033 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007034 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007035 a single "listen" section.
7036
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007037 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7038 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7039 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7040
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007041 Example :
7042 listen tse-farm
7043 bind :3389
7044 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7045 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7046 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7047 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7048 persist rdp-cookie
7049 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007050 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007051 balance rdp-cookie
7052 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7053 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7054
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007055 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7056 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007057
7058
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007059rate-limit sessions <rate>
7060 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7062 yes | yes | yes | no
7063 Arguments :
7064 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7065 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7066
7067 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7068 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7069 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7070 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7071 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7072 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7073
7074 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7075 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7076 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7077 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7078
7079 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7080 listen smtp
7081 mode tcp
7082 bind :25
7083 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007084 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007085
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007086 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7087 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7088 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007089
7090 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7091
7092
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007093redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7094redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7095redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007096 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7098 no | yes | yes | yes
7099
7100 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007101 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007102
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007103 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007104 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007105 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7106 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7107 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007108
7109 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7110 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7111 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7112 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7113 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007114 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7115 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7116 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7117 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007118
7119 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7120 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7121 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7122 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7123 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7124 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007125 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007126 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007127 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7128 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7129 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007130
7131 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007132 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7133 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7134 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007135 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007136 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7137 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7138 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7139 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007140
7141 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7142 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7143
7144 - "drop-query"
7145 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7146 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7147 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7148 with a location-type redirect.
7149
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007150 - "append-slash"
7151 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7152 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7153 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7154 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7155
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007156 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7157 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7158 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7159 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7160 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7161 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7162 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7163
7164 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7165 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7166 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7167 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7168 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7169 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7170 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007171
7172 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7173 acl clear dst_port 80
7174 acl secure dst_port 8080
7175 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007176 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007177 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007178 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7179
7180 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007181 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7182 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7183 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007184 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007185
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007186 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7187 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7188 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7189
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007190 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007191 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007192
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007193 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007194 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7195 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7196 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007198 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007199
7200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007201redisp (deprecated)
7202redispatch (deprecated)
7203 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7205 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007206 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007207
7208 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7209 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7210 be able to access the service anymore.
7211
7212 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7213 redistribute them to a working server.
7214
7215 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7216 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7217 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007219 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7220 "option redispatch" instead.
7221
7222 See also : "option redispatch"
7223
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007224
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007225reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007226 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7228 no | yes | yes | yes
7229 Arguments :
7230 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7231 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007232 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007233
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007234 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7235 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7236
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007237 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7238 the last header of an HTTP request.
7239
7240 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7241 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7242 responses.
7243
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007244 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7245 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7246 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7247
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007248 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7249 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007250
7251
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007252reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7253reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007254 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7255 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7256 no | yes | yes | yes
7257 Arguments :
7258 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7259 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7260 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7261 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7262 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7263 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7264 ignores case.
7265
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007266 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7267 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7268
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007269 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7270 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7271 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7272 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007273 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007274
7275 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7276 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7277
7278 Example :
7279 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7280 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7281 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7282
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007283 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7284 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007285
7286
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007287reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7288reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007289 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7291 no | yes | yes | yes
7292 Arguments :
7293 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7294 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7295 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7296 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7297 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7298 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7299
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007300 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7301 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7302
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007303 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7304 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7305 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7306 next servers.
7307
7308 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7309 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7310 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7311
7312 Example :
7313 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7314 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7315 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7316
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007317 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7318 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007319
7320
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007321reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7322reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007323 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7325 no | yes | yes | yes
7326 Arguments :
7327 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7328 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7329 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7330 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7331 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7332 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7333 case.
7334
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007335 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7336 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7337
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007338 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7339 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7340 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7341 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007342 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007343
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007344 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007345 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007346 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007347
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007348 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7349 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7350
7351 Example :
7352 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7353 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7354 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7355
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007356 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7357 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007358
7359
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007360reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7361reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007362 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7364 no | yes | yes | yes
7365 Arguments :
7366 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7367 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7368 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7369 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7370 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7371 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7372 case.
7373
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007374 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7375 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7376
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007377 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7378 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7379 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7380 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7381
7382 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7383 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7384
7385 Example :
7386 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7387 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7388 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7389 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7390
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007391 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7392 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007393
7394
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007395reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7396reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007397 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7399 no | yes | yes | yes
7400 Arguments :
7401 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7402 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7403 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7404 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7405 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7406 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7407
7408 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7409 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7410 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7411 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007412 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007413
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007414 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7415 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7416
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007417 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7418 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7419 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7420
7421 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7422 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7423 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7424 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7425 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7426
7427 Example :
7428 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007429 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007430 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7431 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7432
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007433 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7434 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007435
7436
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007437reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7438reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007439 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 no | yes | yes | yes
7442 Arguments :
7443 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7444 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7445 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7446 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7447 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7448 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7449 ignores case.
7450
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007451 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7452 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7453
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007454 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7455 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007456 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7457 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7458 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007459 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7460 not set.
7461
7462 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7463 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7464 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7465 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7466 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7467
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007468 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007469 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7470 # block all others.
7471 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7472 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7473
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007474 # block bad guys
7475 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7476 reqitarpit . if badguys
7477
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007478 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7479 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007480
7481
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007482retries <value>
7483 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7484 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7485 yes | no | yes | yes
7486 Arguments :
7487 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7488 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7489 default value is 3.
7490
7491 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7492 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7493 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7494
7495 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007496 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7497 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007498
7499 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7500 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7501
7502 See also : "option redispatch"
7503
7504
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007505rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007506 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7508 no | yes | yes | yes
7509 Arguments :
7510 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7511 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007512 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007513
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007514 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7515 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7516
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007517 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7518 the last header of an HTTP response.
7519
7520 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7521 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7522 responses.
7523
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007524 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7525 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007526
7527
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007528rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7529rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007530 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7532 no | yes | yes | yes
7533 Arguments :
7534 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7535 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7536 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7537 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7538 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7539 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7540 ignores case.
7541
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007542 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7543 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7544
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007545 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7546 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007547 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007548 client.
7549
7550 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7551 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7552 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7553
7554 Example :
7555 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007556 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007557
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007558 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7559 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007560
7561
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007562rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7563rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007564 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7566 no | yes | yes | yes
7567 Arguments :
7568 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7569 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7570 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7571 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7572 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7573 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7574 ignores case.
7575
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007576 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7577 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7578
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007579 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7580 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7581 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7582 case-sensitive.
7583
7584 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007585 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7586 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7587 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007588
7589 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7590 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7591
7592 Example :
7593 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7594 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7595
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007596 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7597 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007598
7599
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007600rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7601rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007602 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7604 no | yes | yes | yes
7605 Arguments :
7606 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7607 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7608 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7609 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7610 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7611 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7612 ignores case.
7613
7614 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7615 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7616 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7617 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007618 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007619
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007620 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7621 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7622
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007623 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7624 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7625 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7626
7627 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7628 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7629 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7630 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7631 are not case-sensitive.
7632
7633 Example :
7634 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7635 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7636
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007637 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7638 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007639
7640
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007641server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007642 Declare a server in a backend
7643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7644 no | no | yes | yes
7645 Arguments :
7646 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007647 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007648 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007649
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007650 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7651 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7652 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7653 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007654 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7655 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7656 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7657 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7658 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007659 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7660 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7661 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7662 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7663 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7664 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7665 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007666 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007667 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7668 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007669 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7670 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007672 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007673 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7674 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7675 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7676 adding this value to the client's port.
7677
7678 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7679 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007680 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007681
7682 Examples :
7683 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7684 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007685 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007686 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7687 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7688 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007689
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007690 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7691 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7692 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7693 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7694 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7695
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007696 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7697 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007698
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007699server-state-file-name [<file>]
7700 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7701 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7702 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7703 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7704 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7705 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7706
7707 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7708 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7709
7710 global
7711 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7712
7713 backend bk
7714 load-server-state-from-file
7715
7716 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7717 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007718
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007719server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7720 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7721 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7723 no | no | yes | yes
7724
7725 Arguments:
7726 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7727
7728 <num | range>
7729 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7730 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7731 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7732 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7733
7734 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7735
7736 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7737
7738 <params*>
7739 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7740 keyword.
7741
7742 Examples:
7743 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7744 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7745 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7746
7747 # or
7748 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7749
7750 # would be equivalent to:
7751 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7752 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7753 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7754
7755
7756
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007757source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007758source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007759source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007760 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7761 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7762 yes | no | yes | yes
7763 Arguments :
7764 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7765 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007766
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007767 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007768 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7769 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7770 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7771 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7772 supported prefixes are :
7773 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7774 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7775 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007776 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007777 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7778 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007779
7780 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7781 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007782 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7783 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7784 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007785
7786 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7787 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7788 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7789 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7790 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7791 <addr>.
7792
7793 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7794 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7795 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7796 port.
7797
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007798 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7799 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7800 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7801 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007802 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007803 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7804 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7805 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7806 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7807 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7808 HTTP header.
7809
7810 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7811 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007812 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007813 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7814 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7815 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7816 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7817 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7818 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7819 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7820
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007821 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7822 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7823 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7824 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7825 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7826 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7827
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007828 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7829 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7830 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7831 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7832
7833 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7834 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7835 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7836 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7837 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7838 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7839
7840 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7841 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7842 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7843 there are two methods :
7844
7845 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7846 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7847 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7848 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7849 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7850 of the client ranges may be used.
7851
7852 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7853 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7854 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7855 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7856 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7857 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7858 same session.
7859
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007860 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7861 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7862 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007863 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007864
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007865 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7866
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007867 Examples :
7868 backend private
7869 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7870 source 192.168.1.200
7871
7872 backend transparent_ssl1
7873 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7874 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7875
7876 backend transparent_ssl2
7877 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7878 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7879 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7880
7881 backend transparent_ssl3
7882 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7883 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7884 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7885
7886 backend transparent_smtp
7887 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7888 # with Tproxy version 4.
7889 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7890
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007891 backend transparent_http
7892 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7893 # proxy.
7894 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7895
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007896 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007897 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7898
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007899
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007900srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7901 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7903 yes | no | yes | yes
7904 Arguments :
7905 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7906 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7907 as explained at the top of this document.
7908
7909 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7910 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7911 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7912 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7913 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7914 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7915 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7916
7917 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7918 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7919 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7920 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7921 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007922 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007923 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007924 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007925
7926 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7927 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7928 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7929 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7930 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7931 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7932
7933 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7934 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7935
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007936 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7937 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007938
7939
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007940stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7941 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007943 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007944
7945 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7946 matched.
7947
7948 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7949 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7950
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007951 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7952 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7953 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7954
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007955 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7956 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7957 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7958 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007959
7960 Example :
7961 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7962 backend stats_localhost
7963 stats enable
7964 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7965
7966 Example :
7967 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7968 backend stats_auth
7969 stats enable
7970 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7971 stats admin if TRUE
7972
7973 Example :
7974 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7975 userlist stats-auth
7976 group admin users admin
7977 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7978 group readonly users haproxy
7979 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7980
7981 backend stats_auth
7982 stats enable
7983 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7984 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7985 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7986 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7987
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007988 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7989 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7990 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007991
7992
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007993stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7994 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007996 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007997 Arguments :
7998 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7999
8000 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8001
8002 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8003 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8004 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8005 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8006 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8007 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8008
8009 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8010 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8011 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008012 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008013
8014 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8015 report using "stats scope".
8016
8017 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8018 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8019 unobvious parameters.
8020
8021 Example :
8022 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8023 backend public_www
8024 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8025 stats enable
8026 stats hide-version
8027 stats scope .
8028 stats uri /admin?stats
8029 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8030 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8031 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8032
8033 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8034 backend private_monitoring
8035 stats enable
8036 stats uri /admin?stats
8037 stats refresh 5s
8038
8039 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8040
8041
8042stats enable
8043 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008045 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008046 Arguments : none
8047
8048 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8049 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8050 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8051 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8052 - stats auth : no authentication
8053 - stats scope : no restriction
8054
8055 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8056 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8057 unobvious parameters.
8058
8059 Example :
8060 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8061 backend public_www
8062 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8063 stats enable
8064 stats hide-version
8065 stats scope .
8066 stats uri /admin?stats
8067 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8068 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8069 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8070
8071 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8072 backend private_monitoring
8073 stats enable
8074 stats uri /admin?stats
8075 stats refresh 5s
8076
8077 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8078
8079
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008080stats hide-version
8081 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008082 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008083 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008084 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008085
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008086 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8087 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8088 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8089 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8090 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8091 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008092
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008093 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8094 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8095 unobvious parameters.
8096
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008097 Example :
8098 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8099 backend public_www
8100 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008101 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008102 stats hide-version
8103 stats scope .
8104 stats uri /admin?stats
8105 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8106 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8107 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008108
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008109 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8110 backend private_monitoring
8111 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008112 stats uri /admin?stats
8113 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008114
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008115 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008116
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008117
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008118stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8119 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8120 Access control for statistics
8121
8122 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8123 no | no | yes | yes
8124
8125 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8126 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8127 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8128 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8129 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8130 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8131
8132 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8133 instance.
8134
8135 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8136 about ACL usage.
8137
8138
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008139stats realm <realm>
8140 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008142 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008143 Arguments :
8144 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8145 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8146 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8147
8148 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8149 using a backslash ('\').
8150
8151 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8152 only related to authentication.
8153
8154 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8155 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8156 unobvious parameters.
8157
8158 Example :
8159 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8160 backend public_www
8161 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8162 stats enable
8163 stats hide-version
8164 stats scope .
8165 stats uri /admin?stats
8166 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8167 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8168 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8169
8170 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8171 backend private_monitoring
8172 stats enable
8173 stats uri /admin?stats
8174 stats refresh 5s
8175
8176 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8177
8178
8179stats refresh <delay>
8180 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008182 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008183 Arguments :
8184 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8185 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8186 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8187 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8188 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8189 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8190
8191 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8192 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8193 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8194 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8195
8196 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8197 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8198 unobvious parameters.
8199
8200 Example :
8201 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8202 backend public_www
8203 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8204 stats enable
8205 stats hide-version
8206 stats scope .
8207 stats uri /admin?stats
8208 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8209 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8210 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8211
8212 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8213 backend private_monitoring
8214 stats enable
8215 stats uri /admin?stats
8216 stats refresh 5s
8217
8218 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8219
8220
8221stats scope { <name> | "." }
8222 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008224 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008225 Arguments :
8226 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8227 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8228 section in which the statement appears.
8229
8230 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8231 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8232 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8233 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8234 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8235 exists.
8236
8237 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8238 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8239 unobvious parameters.
8240
8241 Example :
8242 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8243 backend public_www
8244 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8245 stats enable
8246 stats hide-version
8247 stats scope .
8248 stats uri /admin?stats
8249 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8250 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8251 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8252
8253 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8254 backend private_monitoring
8255 stats enable
8256 stats uri /admin?stats
8257 stats refresh 5s
8258
8259 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8260
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008261
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008262stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008263 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008265 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008266
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008267 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008268 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8269
8270 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8271 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8272
8273 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8274 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008275 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008276
8277 Example :
8278 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8279 backend private_monitoring
8280 stats enable
8281 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8282 stats uri /admin?stats
8283 stats refresh 5s
8284
8285 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8286 global section.
8287
8288
8289stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008290 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8292 yes | yes | yes | yes
8293 Arguments : none
8294
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008295 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008296 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8297 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8298 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8299 - IP (socket, server)
8300 - cookie (backend, server)
8301
8302 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8303 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008304 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008305
8306 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8307
8308
8309stats show-node [ <name> ]
8310 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008312 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008313 Arguments:
8314 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8315 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8316
8317 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8318 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008319 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008320
8321 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8322 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8323 unobvious parameters.
8324
8325 Example:
8326 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8327 backend private_monitoring
8328 stats enable
8329 stats show-node Europe-1
8330 stats uri /admin?stats
8331 stats refresh 5s
8332
8333 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8334 section.
8335
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008336
8337stats uri <prefix>
8338 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008340 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008341 Arguments :
8342 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8343 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8344 query string.
8345
8346 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8347 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8348 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8349 possible to reach it in the application.
8350
8351 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008352 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008353 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8354 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8355 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8356 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8357
8358 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8359 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8360 an address or a port to statistics only.
8361
8362 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8363 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8364 unobvious parameters.
8365
8366 Example :
8367 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8368 backend public_www
8369 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8370 stats enable
8371 stats hide-version
8372 stats scope .
8373 stats uri /admin?stats
8374 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8375 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8376 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8377
8378 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8379 backend private_monitoring
8380 stats enable
8381 stats uri /admin?stats
8382 stats refresh 5s
8383
8384 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8385
8386
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008387stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8388 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008390 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008391
8392 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008393 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008394 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8395 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8396 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8397
8398 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8399 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8400 the "stick-table" statement.
8401
8402 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8403 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8404 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8405 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8406 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8407
8408 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8409 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8410 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8411 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8412 transformation rules.
8413
8414 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8415 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8416 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8417 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8418 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8419 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8420 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8421
8422 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8423 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8424 ACL based conditions.
8425
8426 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8427 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8428 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8429 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8430
8431 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8432 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8433 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8434 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8435
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008436 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8437 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8438 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8439
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008440 Example :
8441 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8442 # last 30 minutes
8443 backend pop
8444 mode tcp
8445 balance roundrobin
8446 stick store-request src
8447 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8448 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8449 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8450
8451 backend smtp
8452 mode tcp
8453 balance roundrobin
8454 stick match src table pop
8455 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8456 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8457
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008458 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008459 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008460
8461
8462stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8463 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8465 no | no | yes | yes
8466
8467 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8468 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8469 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8470 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8471
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008472 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8473 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8474 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8475
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008476 Examples :
8477 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008478 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008479
8480 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8481 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8482 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8483
8484
8485 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8486 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8487 backend http
8488 mode http
8489 balance roundrobin
8490 stick on src table https
8491 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8492 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8493 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8494
8495 backend https
8496 mode tcp
8497 balance roundrobin
8498 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8499 stick on src
8500 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8501 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8502
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008503 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008504
8505
8506stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8507 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8509 no | no | yes | yes
8510
8511 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008512 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008513 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8514 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8515 server is selected.
8516
8517 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8518 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8519 the "stick-table" statement.
8520
8521 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8522 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8523 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8524 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8525 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8526 address.
8527
8528 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8529 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8530 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8531 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8532 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8533 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8534 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8535 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8536 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8537 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8538
8539 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8540 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8541 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8542 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8543 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8544 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8545 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8546
8547 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8548 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8549 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8550 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8551
8552 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8553 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8554 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8555 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8556 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8557 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008558 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8559 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8560 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8561 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8562 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8563 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008564
8565 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8566 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8567 the request.
8568
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008569 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8570 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8571 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8572
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008573 Example :
8574 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8575 # last 30 minutes
8576 backend pop
8577 mode tcp
8578 balance roundrobin
8579 stick store-request src
8580 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8581 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8582 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8583
8584 backend smtp
8585 mode tcp
8586 balance roundrobin
8587 stick match src table pop
8588 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8589 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8590
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008591 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008592 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008593
8594
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008595stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008596 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8597 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008598 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008600 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008601
8602 Arguments :
8603 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8604 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8605 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8606 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8607
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008608 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8609 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8610 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8611 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8612
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008613 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8614 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8615 instance.
8616
8617 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8618 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8619 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8620 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8621 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8622 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008623 to 32 characters.
8624
8625 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8626 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8627 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008628 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008629 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8630 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008631
8632 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008633 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8634 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008635 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8636 increase.
8637
8638 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008639 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8640 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8641 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008642
8643 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8644 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8645 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8646 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8647 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8648 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8649 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8650 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8651 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8652 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8653 parameter (see below).
8654
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008655 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8656 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8657 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8658 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8659 soft restart.
8660
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008661 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8662 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008663
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008664 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8665 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8666 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8667 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008668 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008669 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008670 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8671 if not expiration delay is specified.
8672
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008673 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8674 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8675 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8676 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008677 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8678 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8679 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8680 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8681 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8682 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8683 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8684 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8685 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8686 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8687 types and their arguments.
8688
8689 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8690 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8691 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8692 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8693
8694 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8695 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8696 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8697 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8698
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008699 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8700 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8701 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8702 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8703 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8704 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8705
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008706 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8707 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8708 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8709 they were received.
8710
8711 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8712 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8713 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8714 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8715 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8716
8717 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8718 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8719 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8720 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8721 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8722
8723 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8724 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8725 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8726
8727 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8728 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8729 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8730 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8731 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8732
8733 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8734 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8735 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8736 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8737 the client side.
8738
8739 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8740 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8741 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8742 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8743 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8744 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8745 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8746
8747 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8748 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8749 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8750 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8751 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8752 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8753 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8754
8755 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8756 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8757 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8758 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8759 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8760 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8761
8762 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8763 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8764 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8765 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8766
8767 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8768 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8769 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8770 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8771 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8772 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8773 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8774 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8775 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8776 recommended for better fairness.
8777
8778 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8779 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8780 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8781 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8782
8783 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8784 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8786 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8787 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8788 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8789 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8790 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8791 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8792 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008793
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008794 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8795 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008796 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8797 reference it.
8798
8799 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8800 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008801 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8802 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8803 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008804
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008805 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8806 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8807 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8808 something that can be ignored.
8809
8810 Example:
8811 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8812 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8813 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8814 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8815
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008816 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008817 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008818
8819
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008820stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008821 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8823 no | no | yes | yes
8824
8825 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008826 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008827 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8828 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8829 server is selected.
8830
8831 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8832 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8833 the "stick-table" statement.
8834
8835 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8836 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8837 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8838 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8839
8840 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8841 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8842 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8843 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8844 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8845 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008846 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008847 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8848 rules.
8849
8850 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8851 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8852 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8853 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8854 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8855 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8856 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8857
8858 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8859 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8860 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8861 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8862
8863 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8864 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8865 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8866 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8867 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8868 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008869 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8870 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8871 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8872 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8873 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8874 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8875 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8876 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8877 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008878
8879 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8880
8881 Example :
8882 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8883 backend https
8884 mode tcp
8885 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008886 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008887 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008888
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008889 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8890 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8891
8892 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8893 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8894 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8895
8896 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8897 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008898
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008899 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8900 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8901 # at offset 44.
8902
8903 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8904 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8905
8906 # Learn on response if server hello.
8907 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008908
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008909 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8910 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8911
8912 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8913 extraction.
8914
8915
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008916tcp-check connect [params*]
8917 Opens a new connection
8918 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8919 no | no | yes | yes
8920
8921 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8922 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8923 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8924
8925 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8926 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8927 of the sequence.
8928
8929 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8930 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8931 do.
8932
8933 Parameters :
8934 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8935 use the TCP connection.
8936
8937 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8938 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8939 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8940
8941 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8942
8943 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8944
8945 Examples:
8946 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8947 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8948 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8949 option tcp-check
8950 tcp-check connect
8951 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8952 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8953 tcp-check send \r\n
8954 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8955 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8956 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8957 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8958 tcp-check send \r\n
8959 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8960 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8961
8962 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8963 option tcp-check
8964 tcp-check connect port 110
8965 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8966 tcp-check connect port 143
8967 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8968 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8969
8970 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8971
8972
8973tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8974 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8976 no | no | yes | yes
8977
8978 Arguments :
8979 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8980 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8981 binary.
8982 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8983 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8984 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8985
8986 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8987 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8988 with the usual backslash ('\').
8989 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8990 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8991 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8992 used upper or lower case.
8993
8994
8995 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8996
8997 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8998 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8999 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9000 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9001 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9002 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9003 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9004 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9005
9006 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9007 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9008 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9009 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9010 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9011 expression.
9012
9013 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9014 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9015 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9016 this exact hexadecimal string.
9017 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9018
9019 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9020 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9021 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9022 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9023 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9024 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9025 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9026 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9027 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9028 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9029 the null character.
9030
9031 Examples :
9032 # perform a POP check
9033 option tcp-check
9034 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9035
9036 # perform an IMAP check
9037 option tcp-check
9038 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9039
9040 # look for the redis master server
9041 option tcp-check
9042 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009043 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009044 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9045 tcp-check expect string role:master
9046 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9047 tcp-check expect string +OK
9048
9049
9050 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9051 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9052
9053
9054tcp-check send <data>
9055 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9056 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9057 no | no | yes | yes
9058
9059 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9060 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9061
9062 Examples :
9063 # look for the redis master server
9064 option tcp-check
9065 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9066 tcp-check expect string role:master
9067
9068 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9069 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9070
9071
9072tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
9073 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
9074 tcp health check
9075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9076 no | no | yes | yes
9077
9078 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9079 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9080 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
9081 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9082 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9083 hexadecimal string.
9084 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9085
9086 Examples :
9087 # redis check in binary
9088 option tcp-check
9089 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9090 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9091
9092
9093 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9094 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9095
9096
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009097tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9098 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9100 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009101 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009102 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9103 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009104
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009105 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009106
9107 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9108 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009109 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9110 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9111 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9112 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9113 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9114 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009115
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009116 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9117 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9118 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9119 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009120
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009121 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009122 - accept :
9123 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9124 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9125 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009126
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009127 - reject :
9128 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9129 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9130 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9131 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9132 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9133 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9134 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9135 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9136 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9137 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9138 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009139 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009140
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009141 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9142 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9143 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9144 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9145 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9146 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9147 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9148 hosts.
9149
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009150 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9151 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9152 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9153 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9154 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9155 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9156 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9157 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9158
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009159 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9160 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9161 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9162 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9163 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9164 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9165 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9166 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9167 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009168 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9169 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009170
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009171 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009172 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009173 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009174 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009175 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9176 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009177 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009178 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9179 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9180 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9181 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9182 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009183
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009184 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009185 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009186 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009187 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9188 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9189 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9190 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009191
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009192 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9193 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9194 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9195 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009196
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009197 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9198 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9199 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9200 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9201 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009202 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9203 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9204 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9205 layer7 information is extracted.
9206
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009207 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9208 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9209 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9210 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9211 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009212
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009213 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9214 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9215 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9216 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9217
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009218 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9219 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9220 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9221 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9222 continues.
9223
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009224 - set-src <expr> :
9225 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9226 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9227 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9228 set-src"
9229
9230 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9231 followed by some converters.
9232
9233 Example:
9234
9235 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9236
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009237 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9238 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009239
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009240 - set-src-port <expr> :
9241 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9242 expression.
9243
9244 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9245 followed by some converters.
9246
9247 Example:
9248
9249 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9250
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009251 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9252 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9253 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009254
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009255 - set-dst <expr> :
9256 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9257 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9258 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9259 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9260 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9261
9262 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9263 followed by some converters.
9264
9265 Example:
9266
9267 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9268 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9269
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009270 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9271 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9272
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009273 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9274 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9275 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9276 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9277
9278
9279 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9280 followed by some converters.
9281
9282 Example:
9283
9284 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9285
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009286 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9287 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9288 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9289
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009290 - "silent-drop" :
9291 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9292 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9293 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9294 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9295 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9296 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9297 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9298 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9299 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9300 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9301 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9302 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9303 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9304 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9305 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9306 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9307
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009308 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9309 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9310 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009311
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009312 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9313 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9314 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009315
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009316 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009317 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009318 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009319
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009320 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9321 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9322 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009323
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009324 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009325 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9326 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009327
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009328 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9329
9330 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9331
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009332 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9333
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009334 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009335
9336
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009337tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9338 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009340 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009341 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009342 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9343 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009344
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009345 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009346
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009347 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9348 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9349 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9350 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9351 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009352
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009353 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9354 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9355 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9356 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009357 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9358 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9359 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9360 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9361 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9362 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009363 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009364 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009365
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009366 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9367 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9368 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9369 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009370
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009371 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009372 - accept : the request is accepted
9373 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9374 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009375 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009376 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009377 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009378 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009379 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009380 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009381 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009382
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009383 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9384 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009385
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009386 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9387 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9388 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9389 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9390 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9391 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009393 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009394 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9395 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009396
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009397 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009398 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9399 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9400 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9401 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009402 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9403 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9404 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009405
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009406 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009407 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9408 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9409 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009410
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009411 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009412 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9413 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009414
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009415 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9416 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009417 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009418 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9419 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009420 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009421 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009422 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009423 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9424 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009425 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009426 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9427 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009428
9429 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9430 followed by some converters.
9431
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009432 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9433 <var-name>.
9434
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009435 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9436 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9437 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9438 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9439 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9440
9441 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9442
9443 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9444
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009445 Example:
9446
9447 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009448 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009449
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009450 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009451 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9452 # and reject everything else.
9453 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9454 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009455 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009456 tcp-request content reject
9457
9458 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009459 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9460 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9461 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009462 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009463
9464 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9465 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9466 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009467 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009468 tcp-request content reject
9469
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009470 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009471 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009472 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009473 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009474 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9475 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009476
9477 Example:
9478 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9479 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009480 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009481
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009482 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009483 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009484
9485 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009486 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009487 # protecting all our sites
9488 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009489 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9490 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009491 ...
9492 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9493
9494 backend http_dynamic
9495 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009496 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009497 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009498 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009499 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009500 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009501 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009503 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009504
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009505 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9506 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009507
9508
9509tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9510 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009512 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009513 Arguments :
9514 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9515 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9516 as explained at the top of this document.
9517
9518 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9519 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9520 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9521 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9522 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9523
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009524 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9525 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9526 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9527 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9528
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009529 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9530 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009531 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009532 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009533 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9534 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9535 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9536 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009537
9538 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9539 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9540 it pass through unaffected.
9541
9542 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9543 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9544 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009545 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009546 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9547 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009548 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9549 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9550 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009551
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009552 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009553 "timeout client".
9554
9555
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009556tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9557 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9559 no | no | yes | yes
9560 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009561 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9562 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009563
9564 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9565
9566 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9567 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9568 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009569 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9570 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009571
9572 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9573
9574 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9575 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9576 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9577 inserted.
9578
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009579 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009580 - accept :
9581 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9582 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9583 the rules evaluation.
9584
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009585 - close :
9586 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9587 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9588 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9589 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9590 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9591 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009592 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009593 protocols.
9594
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009595 - reject :
9596 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9597 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009598 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009599
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009600 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9601 Sets a variable.
9602
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009603 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9604 Unsets a variable.
9605
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009606 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9607 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9608 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9609 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9610
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009611 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9612 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9613 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9614 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9615 continues.
9616
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009617 - "silent-drop" :
9618 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9619 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9620 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9621 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9622 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9623 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9624 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9625 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9626 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9627 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9628 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9629 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9630 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9631 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9632 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9633 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9634
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009635 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9636 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9637
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009638 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9639 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9640 for changing the default action to a reject.
9641
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009642 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9643 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9644 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9645 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009646 period.
9647
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009648 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9649 declared inline.
9650
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009651 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9652 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009653 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009654 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9655 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009656 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009657 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009658 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009659 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9660 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009661 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009662 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9663 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009664
9665 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9666 followed by some converters.
9667
9668 Example:
9669
9670 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9671
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009672 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9673 <var-name>.
9674
9675 Example:
9676
9677 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9678
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009679 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9680 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9681 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9682 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9683 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9684
9685 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9686
9687 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9688
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009689 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9690
9691 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9692
9693
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009694tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9695 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9697 no | yes | yes | no
9698 Arguments :
9699 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9700 below.
9701
9702 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9703
9704 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9705 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9706 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9707 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9708 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9709 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9710 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9711 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9712 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9713 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9714 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9715 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9716 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9717 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9718 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9719 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9720 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9721 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9722 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9723 instead.
9724
9725 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9726 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9727 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9728 rules which may be inserted.
9729
9730 Several types of actions are supported :
9731 - accept : the request is accepted
9732 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9733 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9734 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9735 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9736 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009737 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009738 - silent-drop
9739
9740 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9741 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9742 sections for a complete description.
9743
9744 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9745 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9746 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9747
9748 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9749 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9750 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9751 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9752 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9753
9754 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9755 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9756
9757 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9758 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9759 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9760
9761 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9762 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9763 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9764
9765 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9766 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9767 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9768
9769 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9770 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9771 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9772
9773 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9774
9775 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9776
9777
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009778tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9779 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9781 no | no | yes | yes
9782 Arguments :
9783 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9784 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9785 as explained at the top of this document.
9786
9787 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9788
9789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009790timeout check <timeout>
9791 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9792 established.
9793
9794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9795 yes | no | yes | yes
9796 Arguments:
9797 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9798 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9799 as explained at the top of this document.
9800
9801 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9802 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9803 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9804 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009805 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9806 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9807 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009808
9809 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9810 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9811
9812 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9813 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009814 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009815
9816 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9817 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9818 forget about it.
9819
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009820 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9821 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009822
9823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009824timeout client <timeout>
9825timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9826 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9828 yes | yes | yes | no
9829 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009830 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009831 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9832 as explained at the top of this document.
9833
9834 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9835 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9836 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009837 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9838 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9839 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9840 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009841 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9842 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9843 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009844 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009845 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009846 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9847 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009848 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9849 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009850
9851 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9852 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9853 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9854 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9855 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9856 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9857
9858 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9859 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9860 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9861
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009862 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9863 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009864
9865
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009866timeout client-fin <timeout>
9867 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9869 yes | yes | yes | no
9870 Arguments :
9871 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9872 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9873 as explained at the top of this document.
9874
9875 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9876 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9877 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9878 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9879 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9880 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9881 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +01009882 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
9883 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
9884 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009885
9886 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9887 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9888 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9889
9890 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9891
9892
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009893timeout connect <timeout>
9894timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9895 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9897 yes | no | yes | yes
9898 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009899 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009900 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9901 as explained at the top of this document.
9902
9903 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009904 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009905 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009906 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009907 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9908 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009909
9910 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9911 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9912 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9913 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9914 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9915 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9916
9917 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9918 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9919 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9920
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009921 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9922 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009923
9924
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009925timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9926 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9927 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9928 yes | yes | yes | yes
9929 Arguments :
9930 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9931 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9932 as explained at the top of this document.
9933
9934 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9935 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9936 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9937 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9938 once the request has started to present itself.
9939
9940 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9941 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9942 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9943 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9944 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9945
9946 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9947 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9948 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9949 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9950
9951 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9952 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9953 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9954 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9955 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009956 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009957
9958 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9959 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9960 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9961 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9962
9963 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9964
9965
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009966timeout http-request <timeout>
9967 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009969 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009970 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009971 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009972 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9973 as explained at the top of this document.
9974
9975 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9976 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9977 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9978 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9979 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9980 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9981 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009982 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9983 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9984 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9985 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9986 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009987 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9988 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009989
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009990 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9991 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9992 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9993 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9994 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009995 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009996
9997 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9998 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9999 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
10000 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10001 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10002
10003 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010004 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10005 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10006 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010007
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010008 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010009 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010010
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010011
10012timeout queue <timeout>
10013 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10015 yes | no | yes | yes
10016 Arguments :
10017 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10018 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10019 as explained at the top of this document.
10020
10021 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10022 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10023 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10024 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10025 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10026
10027 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10028 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10029 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10030 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10031
10032 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10033
10034
10035timeout server <timeout>
10036timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10037 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10039 yes | no | yes | yes
10040 Arguments :
10041 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10042 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10043 as explained at the top of this document.
10044
10045 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10046 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10047 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10048 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10049 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10050 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10051 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10052
10053 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10054 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10055 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10056 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10057 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010058 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010059 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010060 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10061 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
10062 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10063 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010064
10065 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10066 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10067 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10068 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10069 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10070 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10071
10072 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10073 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10074 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10075
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010076 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010077
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010078
10079timeout server-fin <timeout>
10080 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10082 yes | no | yes | yes
10083 Arguments :
10084 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10085 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10086 as explained at the top of this document.
10087
10088 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10089 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10090 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10091 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10092 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10093 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10094 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10095 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10096 situations, it should not be needed.
10097
10098 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10099 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10100 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10101
10102 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10103
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010104
10105timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010106 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10108 yes | yes | yes | yes
10109 Arguments :
10110 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10111 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10112 as explained at the top of this document.
10113
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010114 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10115 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10116 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10117 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010118
10119 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10120 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10121 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10122 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010123 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010124
10125 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10126
10127
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010128timeout tunnel <timeout>
10129 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10131 yes | no | yes | yes
10132 Arguments :
10133 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10134 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10135 as explained at the top of this document.
10136
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010137 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010138 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10139 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10140 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10141 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10142 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10143 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10144 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10145 specified.
10146
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010147 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10148 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10149 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10150 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10151 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10152 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10153 state.
10154
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010155 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10156 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10157 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10158 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10159 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10160
10161 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10162 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10163 forget about it.
10164
10165 Example :
10166 defaults http
10167 option http-server-close
10168 timeout connect 5s
10169 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010170 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010171 timeout server 30s
10172 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10173
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010174 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010175
10176
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010177transparent (deprecated)
10178 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010180 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010181 Arguments : none
10182
10183 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10184 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10185 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10186 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10187 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10188 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10189 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10190 appropriate server.
10191
10192 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10193
10194 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10195 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10196
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010197 See also: "option transparent"
10198
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010199unique-id-format <string>
10200 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10202 yes | yes | yes | no
10203 Arguments :
10204 <string> is a log-format string.
10205
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010206 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10207 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10208 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10209 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010210
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010211 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10212 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10213 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10214 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10215 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10216 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10217 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10218 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010219
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010220 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10221 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010222
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010223 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010224
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010225 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010226
10227 will generate:
10228
10229 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10230
10231 See also: "unique-id-header"
10232
10233unique-id-header <name>
10234 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10236 yes | yes | yes | no
10237 Arguments :
10238 <name> is the name of the header.
10239
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010240 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10241 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010242
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010243 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010244
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010245 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010246 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10247
10248 will generate:
10249
10250 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10251
10252 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010253
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010254use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010255 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10257 no | yes | yes | no
10258 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010259 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10260 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010261
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010262 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10263 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010264
10265 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10266 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10267 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010268 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10269 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10270 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10271 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010272
10273 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10274 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10275 assign the backend.
10276
10277 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10278 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10279 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10280 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10281 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10282 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10283
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010284 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010285 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010286 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10287 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10288 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10289
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010290 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10291 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10292 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10293 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10294 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10295 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10296 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10297 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10298 cannot be forced from the request.
10299
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010300 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010301 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10302 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10303
10304 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10305 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010306
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010307
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010308use-server <server> if <condition>
10309use-server <server> unless <condition>
10310 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10312 no | no | yes | yes
10313 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010314 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010315
10316 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10317
10318 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10319 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10320 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10321
10322 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10323 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10324 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10325 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10326 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10327 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10328 matches will assign the server.
10329
10330 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10331 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10332 with the next rules until one matches.
10333
10334 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10335 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10336 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10337 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10338
10339 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10340 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10341 stripped.
10342
10343 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10344 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10345 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10346 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10347
10348 Example :
10349 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10350 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10351 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10352 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10353 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10354 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010355 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010356 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10357 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10358
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010359 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010360
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010361
103625. Bind and Server options
10363--------------------------
10364
10365The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10366depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10367settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10368written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10369described in this section.
10370
10371
103725.1. Bind options
10373-----------------
10374
10375The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10376as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10377no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10378parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10379while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10380provided immediately after the setting name.
10381
10382The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10383
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010384accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10385 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10386 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10387 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10388 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10389 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10390 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10391 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10392 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10393 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010394 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10395 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10396 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010397
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010398accept-proxy
10399 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010400 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10401 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010402 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10403 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10404 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10405 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10406 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10407 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10408 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010409 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10410 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010411
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010412allow-0rtt
10413 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10414 due to security considerations.
10415
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010416alpn <protocols>
10417 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10418 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10419 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10420 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10421 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10422 initial NPN extension.
10423
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010424backlog <backlog>
10425 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10426 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10427
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010428curves <curves>
10429 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10430 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10431 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10432 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10433 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10434 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10435
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010436ecdhe <named curve>
10437 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010438 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10439 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010440
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010441ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10443 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10444 client's certificate.
10445
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010446ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10448 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10449 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10450 error is ignored.
10451
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010452ca-sign-file <cafile>
10453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10454 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10455 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10456 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10457 'generate-certificates' for details.
10458
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010459ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010460 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10461 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10462 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10463 'generate-certificates' for details.
10464
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010465ciphers <ciphers>
10466 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10467 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010468 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010469 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10470 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010471 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10472 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10473 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10474 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010475
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010476crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010477 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10478 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10479 to verify client's certificate.
10480
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010481crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010482 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10483 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10484 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10485 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10486 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10487 file.
10488
10489 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10490 are loaded.
10491
10492 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010493 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010494 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10495 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10496 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10497 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10498 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10499 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10500 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010501
10502 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10503 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10504 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10505 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010506 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10507 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010508
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010509 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010510
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010511 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10512 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010513 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010514 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10515 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10516 clients).
10517
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010518 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10519 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10520 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10521 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10522 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10523 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10524 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10525 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10526 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10527 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10528 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10529 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10530 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10531
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010532 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10533 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10534 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10535 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10536 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10537
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010538 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10539 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10540 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10541 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010542
10543 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10544 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10545 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10546 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10547 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10548 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10549 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10550 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10551 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10552
10553 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10554
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010555 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010556 a cert bundle.
10557
10558 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10559 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10560 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10561 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10562 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10563 provide multi-cert support.
10564
10565 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10566
10567 Filename | CN | SAN
10568 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10569 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010570 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010571 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10572 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10573
10574 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10575 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10576 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10577 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010578 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10579 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10580 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010581
10582 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10583 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10584
10585 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10586 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10587 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10588
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010589crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10591 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010592 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010593 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010594
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010595crt-list <file>
10596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010597 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10598 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010599
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010600 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10601
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010602 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10603 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010604 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010605 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010606
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010607 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10608 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10609 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10610 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10611 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10612 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10613 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10614 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010615
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010616 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010617 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010618 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10619 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10620 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010621
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010622 crt-list file example:
10623 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010624 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010625 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010626 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010627
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010628defer-accept
10629 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10630 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10631 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10632 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10633 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10634 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10635 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10636 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10637 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10638 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10639 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10640
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010641expose-fd listeners
10642 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10643 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010644 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10645 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010646 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10647
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010648force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010649 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010650 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010651 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010652 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010653
10654force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010655 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010656 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010657 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010658
10659force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010660 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010661 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010662 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010663
10664force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010665 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010666 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010667 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010668
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010669force-tlsv13
10670 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10671 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010672 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010673
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010674generate-certificates
10675 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10676 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10677 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10678 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10679 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10680 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10681 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10682 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10683 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10684 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10685 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10686
10687 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10688 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10689 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10690 certificate is used many times.
10691
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010692gid <gid>
10693 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10694 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10695 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10696 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10697 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10698
10699group <group>
10700 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10701 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10702 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10703 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10704 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10705
10706id <id>
10707 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10708 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10709 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10710 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10711
10712interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010713 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10714 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10715 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10716 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10717 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10718 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10719 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010720
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010721level <level>
10722 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10723 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10724 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10725 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10726 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10727 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10728 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10729 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10730 counters).
10731 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10732 all counters).
10733
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010734severity-output <format>
10735 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10736 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10737 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10738 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10739 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10740 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10741 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10742 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10743 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10744 rfc5424 convention.
10745
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010746maxconn <maxconn>
10747 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10748 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10749 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10750 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10751 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10752 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10753 eat all memory.
10754
10755mode <mode>
10756 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10757 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10758 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10759 UNIX sockets.
10760
10761mss <maxseg>
10762 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10763 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10764 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10765 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10766 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10767 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10768 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10769 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10770 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10771 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10772 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10773
10774name <name>
10775 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10776 page.
10777
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010778namespace <name>
10779 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10780 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10781 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10782 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10783
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010784nice <nice>
10785 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10786 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10787 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10788 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10789 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10790 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10791 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10792 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10793 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10794 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10795 one for an RDP socket.
10796
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010797no-ca-names
10798 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10799 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10800
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010801no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010803 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010804 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010805 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010806 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10807 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010808
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010809no-tls-tickets
10810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10811 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10812 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010813 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10814 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010815
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010816no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010818 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010819 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010820 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010821 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10822 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010823
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010824no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010826 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010827 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010828 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010829 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10830 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010831
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010832no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010834 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010835 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010836 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010837 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10838 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010839
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010840no-tlsv13
10841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10842 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10843 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10844 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010845 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10846 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010847
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010848npn <protocols>
10849 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10850 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10851 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10852 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010853 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10854 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010855
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010856prefer-client-ciphers
10857 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10858 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10859 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10860
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010010861process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
10862 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
10863 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
10864 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
10865 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
10866 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
10867 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
10868 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
10869 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process inoming
10870 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
10871 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
10872 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
10873
10874 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
10875
10876 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
10877 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
10878 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
10879 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
10880 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
10881 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
10882 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
10883 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010884
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010885ssl
10886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010887 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010888 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10889 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010890 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10891 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010892
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010893ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10894 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10895 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10896 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10897
10898ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10899 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10900 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10901 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10902
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010903strict-sni
10904 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10905 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10906 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10907 See the "crt" option for more information.
10908
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010909tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010910 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010911 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10912 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010913 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010914 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10915 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10916 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10917 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10918 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10919 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10920 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10921
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010922tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010923 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010924 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10925 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10926 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10927 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10928 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10929 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10930 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010931 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10932 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10933 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010934
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010935tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10936 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10937 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10938 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10939 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10940 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10941 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10942 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10943 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10944 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10945 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10946
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010947transparent
10948 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10949 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10950 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10951 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10952 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10953 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10954 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10955 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10956 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10957 so check for support with your vendor.
10958
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010959v4v6
10960 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10961 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10962 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10963 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010964 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010965
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010966v6only
10967 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10968 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10969 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010970 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10971 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010972
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010973uid <uid>
10974 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10975 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10976 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10977 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10978 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10979
10980user <user>
10981 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10982 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10983 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10984 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10985 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10986
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010987verify [none|optional|required]
10988 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10989 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10990 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10991 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10992 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010993 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10994 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10995 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10996 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010997
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200109985.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010999------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011001The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11002which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11003arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11004settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11005after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11006Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11007address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011009 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011010 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011011
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011012Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11013keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011015The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011016
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011017addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011018 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011019 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11020 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11021 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11022 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11023 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011024
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011025agent-check
11026 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011027 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
11028 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
11029 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
11030 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011031
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011032 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011033 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011034 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11035 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11036 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011037
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011038 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
11039 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11040 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
11041 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
11042 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
11043
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011044 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11045 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011046
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011047 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11048 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11049 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011050
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011051 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11052 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11053 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011054
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011055 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11056 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11057 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11058 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11059 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
11060 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
11061 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011062
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011063 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11064 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011065
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011066 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11067 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11068 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11069 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11070 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11071 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11072 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11073 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11074 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011075
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011076 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11077 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011078 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11079 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11080 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011081 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011082
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011083 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011084 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011085
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011086agent-send <string>
11087 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11088 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11089 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11090 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11091 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11092
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011093agent-inter <delay>
11094 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11095 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11096
11097 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11098 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11099 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11100 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11101 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11102 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11103 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11104 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11105 of backends use the same servers.
11106
11107 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11108
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011109agent-addr <addr>
11110 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11111
11112 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11113 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11114 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11115 hostname, it will be resolved.
11116
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011117agent-port <port>
11118 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11119
11120 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011122backup
11123 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11124 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11125 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11126 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011127 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11128 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011129
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011130ca-file <cafile>
11131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11132 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11133 server's certificate.
11134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011135check
11136 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011137 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11138 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11139 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11140 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11141 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11142 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11143 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011144 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11145 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011146 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11147 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011148
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011149check-send-proxy
11150 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11151 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11152 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11153 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11154 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11155 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11156 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11157
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011158check-sni
11159 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11160 over SSL.
11161
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011162check-ssl
11163 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11164 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11165 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11166 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011167 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011168 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11169 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11170 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011171 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11172 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011173
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011174ciphers <ciphers>
11175 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011176 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011177 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11178 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11179 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11180 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11181 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11182 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011184cookie <value>
11185 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11186 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11187 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11188 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11189 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11190 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11191 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11192
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011193crl-file <crlfile>
11194 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11195 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11196 to verify server's certificate.
11197
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011198crt <cert>
11199 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11200 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11201 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11202 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11203 certificate request.
11204
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011205disabled
11206 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11207 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11208 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11209 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11210 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011211 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011212
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011213enabled
11214 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11215 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11216 default value.
11217 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11218 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011219
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011220error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011221 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11222 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11223 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011225 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011227fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011228 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11229 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11230 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11231
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011232force-sslv3
11233 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11234 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011235 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011236 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011237
11238force-tlsv10
11239 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011240 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011241 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011242
11243force-tlsv11
11244 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011245 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011246 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011247
11248force-tlsv12
11249 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011250 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011251 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011252
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011253force-tlsv13
11254 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11255 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011256 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011257
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011258id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011259 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11260 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11261 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011262
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011263init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11264 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11265 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11266 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11267 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11268 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11269 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11270 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11271 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11272 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11273 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11274 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11275 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11276 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11277 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11278 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11279 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11280 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11281 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11282 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11283 historic behaviour.
11284
11285 Example:
11286 defaults
11287 # never fail on address resolution
11288 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011290inter <delay>
11291fastinter <delay>
11292downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011293 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11294 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11295 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11296 between checks depending on the server state :
11297
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011298 Server state | Interval used
11299 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11300 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11301 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11302 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11303 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11304 or yet unchecked. |
11305 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11306 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11307 | "inter" otherwise.
11308 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011310 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11311 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11312 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11313 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011314 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11315 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11316 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11317 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11318 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011320maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011321 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11322 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11323 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11324 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11325 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11326 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11327 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11328 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011330maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011331 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11332 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11333 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11334 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11335 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11336 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11337 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011339minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011340 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11341 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11342 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11343 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11344 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11345 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011346 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011347 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011348
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011349namespace <name>
11350 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11351 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11352 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11353 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11354
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011355no-agent-check
11356 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11357 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11358 default value.
11359 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11360 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11361
11362no-backup
11363 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11364 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11365 default value.
11366 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11367 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11368
11369no-check
11370 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11371 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11372 default value.
11373 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11374 "default-server" "check" setting.
11375
11376no-check-ssl
11377 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11378 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11379 default value.
11380 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11381 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11382
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011383no-send-proxy
11384 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11385 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11386 default value.
11387 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11388 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11389
11390no-send-proxy-v2
11391 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11392 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11393 default value.
11394 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11395 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11396
11397no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11398 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11399 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11400 default value.
11401 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11402 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11403
11404no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11405 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11406 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11407 default value.
11408 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11409 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11410
11411no-ssl
11412 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11413 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11414 default value.
11415 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11416 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11417
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011418no-ssl-reuse
11419 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11420 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11421 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11422 and for paranoid users.
11423
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011424no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011425 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11426 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011427 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011428
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011429 Supported in default-server: No
11430
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011431no-tls-tickets
11432 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11433 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11434 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011435 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11436 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011437 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011438
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011439no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011440 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011441 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11442 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011443 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11444 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011445 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011446
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011447 Supported in default-server: No
11448
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011449no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011450 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011451 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11452 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011453 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11454 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011455 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011456
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011457 Supported in default-server: No
11458
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011459no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011460 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011461 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11462 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011463 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11464 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011465 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011466
11467 Supported in default-server: No
11468
11469no-tlsv13
11470 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11471 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11472 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11473 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11474 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011475 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011476
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011477 Supported in default-server: No
11478
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011479no-verifyhost
11480 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11481 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11482 default value.
11483 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11484 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011485
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011486non-stick
11487 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11488 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11489 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011491observe <mode>
11492 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11493 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11494 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11495 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11496 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11497 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011498 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011499
11500 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011502on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011503 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11504 Currently, four modes are available:
11505 - fastinter: force fastinter
11506 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11507 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11508 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11509 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11510
11511 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11512
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011513on-marked-down <action>
11514 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11515 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011516 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11517 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11518 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11519 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11520 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11521 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11522 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11523 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011524
11525 Actions are disabled by default
11526
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011527on-marked-up <action>
11528 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11529 Currently one action is available:
11530 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11531 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11532 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11533 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11534 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11535 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11536 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11537 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11538
11539 Actions are disabled by default
11540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011541port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011542 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11543 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11544 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11545 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11546 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11547 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11548
11549redir <prefix>
11550 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11551 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11552 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11553 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11554 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11555 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11556 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11557 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011558 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011559 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11560 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11561 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11562 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11563 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11564
11565 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011567rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011568 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11569 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11570 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11571
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011572resolve-prefer <family>
11573 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11574 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11575 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11576 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11577
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011578 Default value: ipv6
11579
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011580 Example:
11581
11582 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011583
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011584resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11585 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11586 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011587 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011588 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11589 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11590 configured network, another address is selected.
11591
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011592 Example:
11593
11594 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011595
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011596resolvers <id>
11597 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11598 hostname.
11599
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011600 Example:
11601
11602 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011603
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011604 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011605
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011606send-proxy
11607 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11608 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11609 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11610 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011611 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11612 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11613 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11614 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11615 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11616 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11617 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11618 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11619 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11620 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011621 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11622 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011623
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011624send-proxy-v2
11625 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11626 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11627 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11628 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011629 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11630 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11631 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11632 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011633
11634send-proxy-v2-ssl
11635 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11636 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11637 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11638 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11639 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11640 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11641 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011642 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11643 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011644
11645send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11646 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11647 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11648 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11649 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11650 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11651 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11652 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11653 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011654 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11655 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011656
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011657slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011658 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11659 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11660 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11661 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11662 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11663 parameters :
11664
11665 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11666 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11667
11668 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11669 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11670 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11671 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11672
11673 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11674 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11675 seen as failed.
11676
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011677sni <expression>
11678 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11679 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11680 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11681 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011682 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11683 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011684 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11685 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011686
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011687source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011688source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011689source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011690 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11691 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11692 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11693 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11694
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011695 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11696 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11697 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11698 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11699 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11700 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11701 server.
11702
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011703 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11704 specifying the source address without port(s).
11705
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011706ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011707 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11708 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11709 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11710 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11711 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11712 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011713 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11714 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011715
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011716ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11717 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11718 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11719 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11720
11721ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11722 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11723 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11724 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11725
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011726ssl-reuse
11727 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11728 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11729 default value.
11730 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11731 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11732
11733stick
11734 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11735 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11736 default value.
11737 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11738 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011739
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011740tcp-ut <delay>
11741 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11742 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11743 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011744 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011745 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11746 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11747 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11748 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11749 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11750 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11751 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11752 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11753 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011755track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011756 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11757 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11758 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11759 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011760 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11761
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011762tls-tickets
11763 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11764 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11765 default value.
11766 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11767 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011768
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011769verify [none|required]
11770 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011771 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011772 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11773 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11774 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11775 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11776 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11777 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11778 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11779 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11780 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11781 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11782 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011783
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011784verifyhost <hostname>
11785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011786 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11787 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11788 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11789 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11790 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11791 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11792 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11793 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011795weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011796 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11797 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11798 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011799 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11800 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11801 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11802 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11803 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11804 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011805
11806
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200118075.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11808-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011809
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011810HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11811using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11812configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011813This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11814can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11815workload.
11816This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11817resolution at run time.
11818Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11819carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11820
11821
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200118225.3.1. Global overview
11823----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011824
11825As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11826different steps of the process life:
11827
11828 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11829 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11830 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11831
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011832 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11833 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011834
11835A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11836 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11837 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11838 resolution to know this new IP.
11839
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011840When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
11841HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
11842SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11843from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11844will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11845will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011846
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011847A few things important to notice:
11848 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11849 first valid response.
11850
11851 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11852 servers return an error.
11853
11854
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200118555.3.2. The resolvers section
11856----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011857
11858This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011859HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11860contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011861
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011862When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11863uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11864is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11865answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11866
11867When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011868used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011869
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011870 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11871 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11872 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011873
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011874 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11875 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011876
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011877 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11878 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11879 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011880
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011881For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11882following scenarios are possible:
11883
11884 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11885 ignored
11886
11887 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11888 applied
11889
11890 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11891 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11892
11893 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11894 retries the query with a new type
11895
11896 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11897 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011898
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011899As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11900a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011901<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011902
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011903
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011904resolvers <resolvers id>
11905 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11906
11907A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11908
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011909accepted_payload_size <nb>
11910 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011911 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011912 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11913 by RFC 6891)
11914
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011915 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011916 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11917
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011918 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11919
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011920nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11921 DNS server description:
11922 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11923 <ip> : IP address of the server
11924 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11925
11926hold <status> <period>
11927 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11928 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011929 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011930 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011931 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11932 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11933 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11934
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011935 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011936
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011937resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011938 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11939 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11940 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11941
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011942resolve_retries <nb>
11943 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11944 giving up.
11945 Default value: 3
11946
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011947 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11948 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11949 type.
11950
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011951timeout <event> <time>
11952 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11953 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11954 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011955 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
11956 other time applied.
11957 Default value: 1s
11958 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
11959 have been received.
11960 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011961 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11962 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11963
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011964 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011965
11966 resolvers mydns
11967 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11968 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11969 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011970 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011971 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011972 hold other 30s
11973 hold refused 30s
11974 hold nx 30s
11975 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011976 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011977 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011978
11979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200119806. HTTP header manipulation
11981---------------------------
11982
11983In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11984response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11985request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11986which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011987against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011988
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011989If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11990to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11991but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11992HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11993stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11994because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11995a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11996still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011997
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011998This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11999in section 4.2 :
12000
12001 - reqadd <string>
12002 - reqallow <search>
12003 - reqiallow <search>
12004 - reqdel <search>
12005 - reqidel <search>
12006 - reqdeny <search>
12007 - reqideny <search>
12008 - reqpass <search>
12009 - reqipass <search>
12010 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12011 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12012 - reqtarpit <search>
12013 - reqitarpit <search>
12014 - rspadd <string>
12015 - rspdel <search>
12016 - rspidel <search>
12017 - rspdeny <search>
12018 - rspideny <search>
12019 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12020 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12021
12022With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12023is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12024parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12025prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12026Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12027
12028 \t for a tab
12029 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12030 \n for a new line (LF)
12031 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12032 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12033 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12034 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12035 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12036
12037The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12038portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12039above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12040regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
120419 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12042is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12043
12044The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12045after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12046
12047Notes related to these keywords :
12048---------------------------------
12049 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12050 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12051 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12052
12053 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12054 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12055 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12056
12057 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12058 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12059 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12060 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12061 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12062
12063 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12064 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12065 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12066 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12067 useless headers before adding new ones.
12068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012069 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012070 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12071
12072 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12073 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12074 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12075
12076 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12077 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012078 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012079
12080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120817. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12082----------------------------------
12083
12084Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
12085client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12086The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12087these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12088but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12089data called patterns.
12090
12091
120927.1. ACL basics
12093---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012094
12095The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12096content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12097from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12098simple :
12099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012100 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012101 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012102 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12103 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012105The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12106adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012107
12108In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012110 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012111
12112This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12113Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12114and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012115an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12116conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12117as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12118are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012119
12120ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12121'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12122which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12123
12124There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12125performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012127The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12128specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12129this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012130methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12131ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012132
12133Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12134 - boolean
12135 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12136 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12137 - string
12138 - data block
12139
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012140Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12141converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12142would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12143The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12144which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12145
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012146Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12147keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12148fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12149which are summarized in the table below :
12150
12151 +---------------------+-----------------+
12152 | Sample or converter | Default |
12153 | output type | matching method |
12154 +---------------------+-----------------+
12155 | boolean | bool |
12156 +---------------------+-----------------+
12157 | integer | int |
12158 +---------------------+-----------------+
12159 | ip | ip |
12160 +---------------------+-----------------+
12161 | string | str |
12162 +---------------------+-----------------+
12163 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12164 +---------------------+-----------------+
12165
12166Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12167matching method, see below.
12168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012169The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12170 - boolean
12171 - integer or integer range
12172 - IP address / network
12173 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12174 - regular expression
12175 - hex block
12176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012177The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12178
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012179 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12180 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012181 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012182 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012183 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012184 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012185 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012187The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12188read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12189if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12190lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12191will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12192beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12193a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12194lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12195exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12196
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012197The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12198parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12199ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12200a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12201check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12202
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012203The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12204socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12205file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012207Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12208loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12209
12210 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12211
12212In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12213the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12214case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12215as well.
12216
12217The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12218sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12219do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12220methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12221is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12222obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12223followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12224default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12225that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12226string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12227
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012228The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12229By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12230string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12231resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12232server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12233waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12234flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12235function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012237There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12238sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12239be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012240
12241 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12242 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012243 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12244 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12245 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12246 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012247
12248 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12249 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012250 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012251
12252 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012253 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012254
12255 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012256 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012257
12258 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12259 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12260
12261 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12262 binary or string samples.
12263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012264 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12265 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012267 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12268 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12269 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012271 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12272 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012274 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12275 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012277 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12278 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012280 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12281 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012282 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012284 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12285 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12286 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012287
12288For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12289request, it is possible to do :
12290
12291 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12292
12293In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12294buffer, one would use the following acl :
12295
12296 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12297
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012298On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12299possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12300
12301 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012303All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12304criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12305method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12306to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12307criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12308the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012310If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012311the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12312For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012314 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12315 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12316 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12317 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012318
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012319
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012320The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12321types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12322combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12323brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12324default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012326 +-------------------------------------------------+
12327 | Input sample type |
12328 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012329 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012330 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12331 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12332 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012333 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012334 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012335 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012336 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012337 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012338 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012339 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012340 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012341 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012342 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012343 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012344 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012345 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012346 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012347 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012348 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012349 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012350 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012351 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012352 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012353 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012354 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12355 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12356 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012357
12358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123597.1.1. Matching booleans
12360------------------------
12361
12362In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12363Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12364When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12365that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12366
12367Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12368return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12369"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12370
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123727.1.2. Matching integers
12373------------------------
12374
12375Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12376enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12377to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12378
12379Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12380matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12381lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012382
12383For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12384unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12385representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12386
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012387As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12388two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12389instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12390ranges and operators.
12391
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012392For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012393operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12394Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12395of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012396
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012397Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012398
12399 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12400 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12401 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12402 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12403 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12404
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012405For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012406
12407 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12408
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012409This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12410
12411 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12412
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124147.1.3. Matching strings
12415-----------------------
12416
12417String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12418different forms :
12419
12420 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12421 patterns ;
12422
12423 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12424 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12425
12426 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12427 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12428
12429 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12430 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12431
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012432 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012433 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12434 matches.
12435
12436 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12437 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12438 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012439
12440String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12441exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12442characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12443string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12444to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012445before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012446
12447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124487.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12449---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012450
12451Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12452they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12453possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12454passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12455the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012456the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12457match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012458
12459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200124607.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12461-------------------------------------
12462
12463It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12464not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12465a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12466to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12467digits may be used upper or lower case.
12468
12469Example :
12470 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12471 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12472
12473
124747.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12475---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012476
12477IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12478netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12479within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012480host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012481difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12482at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12483does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12484parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012485
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012486The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12487abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12488
12489 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12490 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12491 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12492 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12493 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12494 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12495 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12496 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12497
12498Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12499192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12500
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012501IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12502Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12503trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12504IPv6 patterns.
12505
12506HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12507following situations :
12508 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12509 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12510 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12511 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12512 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12513 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12514 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12515 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12516 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12517 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012519
125207.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12521----------------------------------
12522
12523Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12524combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12525
12526 - AND (implicit)
12527 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12528 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012530A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012532 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012534Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12535indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012537For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12538"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12539requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12540is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12541
12542 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012543 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12544 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12545 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012546
12547To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12548and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12549
12550 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12551 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12552 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12553 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12554
12555 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12556 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12557 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12558 use_backend www if host_www
12559
12560It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12561expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12562be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12563the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12564
12565 The following rule :
12566
12567 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012568 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569
12570 Can also be written that way :
12571
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012572 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012573
12574It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12575to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12576simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12577sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12578good use is the following :
12579
12580 With named ACLs :
12581
12582 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12583 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12584 monitor fail if site_dead
12585
12586 With anonymous ACLs :
12587
12588 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12589
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012590See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12591keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012592
12593
125947.3. Fetching samples
12595---------------------
12596
12597Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12598against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12599sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12600ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12601of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12602available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12603
12604This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12605Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12606compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12607deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12608
12609The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12610matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12611method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12612indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12613
12614As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12615when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12616mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12617the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12618ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12619
12620Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12621multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12622when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12623incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12624are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12625is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12626all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12627
12628Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12629 - name
12630 - name(arg1)
12631 - name(arg1,arg2)
12632
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012633
126347.3.1. Converters
12635-----------------
12636
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012637Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12638of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12639is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12640was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12641has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12642unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12643
12644These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12645sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12646the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12647support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012648
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012649A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12650support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12651supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12652(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12653bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012655The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012656
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001265751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12658 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12659 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12660 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12661 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12662 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12663
12664 Example :
12665 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12666 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12667 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12668 frontend http-in
12669 bind *:8081
12670 default_backend servers
12671 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12672 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12673
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012674add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012675 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012676 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012677 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12678 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012679 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012680 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12681 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12682 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12683 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12684 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012685 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012686
12687and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012688 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012689 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012690 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12691 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012692 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012693 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12694 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12695 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12696 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12697 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012698 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012699
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012700b64dec
12701 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12702 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12703
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012704base64
12705 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12706 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12707 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12708
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012709bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012710 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012711 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12712 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12713 presence of a flag).
12714
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012715bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12716 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12717 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012718 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012719
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012720cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012721 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12722 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012723
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012724crc32([<avalanche>])
12725 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12726 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12727 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12728 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12729 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12730 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12731 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12732 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12733 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12734 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12735 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12736
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012737da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012738 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12739 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12740 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12741 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012742 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012743 configuration language.
12744
12745 Example:
12746 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012747 bind *:8881
12748 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012749 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012750
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012751debug
12752 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12753 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12754 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12755
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012756div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012757 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12758 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012759 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012760 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12761 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012762 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012763 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12764 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12765 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12766 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12767 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012768 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012769
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012770djb2([<avalanche>])
12771 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12772 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12773 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12774 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12775 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12776 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12777 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012778 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12779 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012780
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012781even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012782 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012783 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12784
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012785field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12786 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12787 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12788 list of chars.
12789
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012790hex
12791 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12792 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12793 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12794 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012795
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012796hex2i
12797 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12798 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12799
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012800http_date([<offset>])
12801 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12802 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12803 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12804 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12805 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12806 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012807
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012808in_table(<table>)
12809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12811 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12812 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12813 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12814
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012815ipmask(<mask>)
12816 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12817 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12818 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12819 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12820
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012821json([<input-code>])
12822 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12823 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012824 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012825 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12826 of errors:
12827 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12828 bytes, ...)
12829 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12830 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12831
12832 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12833 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12834 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12835 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12836 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12837 are :
12838 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12839 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12840 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12841 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12842 error ;
12843 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12844 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12845
12846 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12847 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12848
12849 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012850 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012851 capture request header user-agent len 150
12852 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012853
12854 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12855 GET / HTTP/1.0
12856 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12857
12858 Output log:
12859 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12860
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012861language(<value>[,<default>])
12862 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12863 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12864 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12865 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12866 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12867 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12868 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12869 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12870 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12871 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12872 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12873 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012874
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012875 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012876
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012877 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12878 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012879
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012880 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12881 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12882 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12883 use_backend spanish if es
12884 use_backend french if fr
12885 use_backend english if en
12886 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012887
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012888lower
12889 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12890 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12891 type. The result is of type string.
12892
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012893ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12894 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12895 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12896 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12897 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12898 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12899 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12900
12901 Example :
12902
12903 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12904 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12905 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12906
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012907map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12908map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12909map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12910 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12911 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12912 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12913 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12914 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12915 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12916 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12917 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012918
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012919 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12920 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12921 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012922
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012923 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012924 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012925
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012926 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12927 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12928 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12929 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012930 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12931 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012932 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12933 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12934 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12935 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12936 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12937 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12938 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12939 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012940 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12941 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12942 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012943 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12944 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12945 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12946 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12947 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012948
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012949 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12950 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12951 the corresponding match text.
12952
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012953 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12954 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12955 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12956 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12957 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012958
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012959 Example :
12960
12961 # this is a comment and is ignored
12962 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12963 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12964 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12965 | | | `---------- value
12966 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12967 | `---------------------------- key
12968 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12969
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012970mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012971 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12972 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012973 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012974 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012975 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012976 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12977 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12978 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12979 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12980 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012981 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012982
12983mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012984 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012985 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12986 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012987 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012988 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012989 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012990 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12991 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12992 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12993 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12994 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012995 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012996
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012997nbsrv
12998 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12999 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13000 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13001 map lookup.
13002
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013003neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013004 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13005 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13006 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13007 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013008
13009not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013010 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013011 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
13012 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
13013 absence of a flag).
13014
13015odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013016 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013017 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13018
13019or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013020 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013021 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013022 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13023 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013024 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013025 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13026 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13027 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13028 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
13029 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013030 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013031
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013032regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013033 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13034 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13035 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13036 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13037 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13038 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13039 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13040 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13041 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13042 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013043 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13044 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13045 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13046 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013047
13048 Example :
13049
13050 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13051 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13052 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13053 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13054
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013055capture-req(<id>)
13056 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13057 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13058
13059 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013060 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13061 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013062
13063capture-res(<id>)
13064 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13065 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13066
13067 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013068 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13069 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013070
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013071sdbm([<avalanche>])
13072 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13073 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13074 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13075 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13076 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13077 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13078 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013079 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
13080 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013081
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013082set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013083 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
13084 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
13085 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013086 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013087 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13088 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013089 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013090 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13091 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013092 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013093 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013094
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013095sha1
13096 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13097 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13098
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013099sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013100 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13101 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013102 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013103 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13104 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013105 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013106 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13107 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013108 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013109 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13110 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013111 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013112 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013113
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013114table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13115 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13116 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13117 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13118 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13119 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13120 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13121
13122
13123table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13124 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13125 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13126 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13127 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13128 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13129 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13130
13131table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13135 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13136 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13137
13138table_conn_cur(<table>)
13139 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13140 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13141 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13142 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13143 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13144
13145table_conn_rate(<table>)
13146 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13147 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13148 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13149 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13150 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13151
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013152table_gpt0(<table>)
13153 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13154 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13155 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13156 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13157 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13158
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013159table_gpc0(<table>)
13160 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13161 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13162 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13163 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13164 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13165
13166table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13167 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13168 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13169 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13170 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13171 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13172 sample fetch keyword.
13173
13174table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13175 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13176 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13177 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13178 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13179 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13180
13181table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13182 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13183 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13184 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13185 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13186 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13187 keyword.
13188
13189table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13190 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13191 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13192 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13193 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13194 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13195
13196table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13197 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13198 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13199 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13200 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13201 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13202 keyword.
13203
13204table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13205 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13206 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13207 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13208 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13209 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13210 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13211 keyword.
13212
13213table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13214 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13215 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13216 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13217 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13218 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13219 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13220 keyword.
13221
13222table_server_id(<table>)
13223 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13224 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13225 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13226 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13227 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13228 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13229
13230table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13231 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13232 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13233 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13234 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13235 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13236 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13237 keyword.
13238
13239table_sess_rate(<table>)
13240 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13241 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13242 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13243 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13244 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13245 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13246 keyword.
13247
13248table_trackers(<table>)
13249 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13250 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13251 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13252 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13253 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13254 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13255 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13256 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13257 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13258 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13259
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013260upper
13261 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13262 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13263 type. The result is of type string.
13264
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013265url_dec
13266 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13267 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13268
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013269unset-var(<var name>)
13270 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13271 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13272 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13273 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13274 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13275 response),
13276 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13277 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13278 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13279 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13280
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013281utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13282 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13283 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13284 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13285 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13286 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13287 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13288
13289 Example :
13290
13291 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13292 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13293 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13294
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013295word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13296 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13297 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13298
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013299wt6([<avalanche>])
13300 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13301 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13302 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13303 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13304 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13305 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13306 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013307 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13308 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013309
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013310xor(<value>)
13311 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013312 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013313 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013314 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013315 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013316 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13317 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013318 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013319 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13320 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013321 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013322 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013323
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013324xxh32([<seed>])
13325 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13326 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13327 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13328 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13329 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13330 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13331 as cryptographically secure.
13332
13333xxh64([<seed>])
13334 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13335 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13336 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13337 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13338 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13339 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13340 as cryptographically secure.
13341
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013342
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133437.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013344--------------------------------------------
13345
13346A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13347not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13348"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13349The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13350
13351always_false : boolean
13352 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13353 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13354
13355always_true : boolean
13356 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13357 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13358
13359avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013360 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013361 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13362 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13363 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13364 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13365 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13366 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13367 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13368 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13369 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13370 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13371 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13372 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13373 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013375be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013376 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13377 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13378 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13379 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13380 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013382be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13383 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13384 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13385 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13386 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13387 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13388 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013389
13390 Example :
13391 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13392 backend dynamic
13393 mode http
13394 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13395 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013396
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013397bin(<hexa>) : bin
13398 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13399 of the string.
13400
13401bool(<bool>) : bool
13402 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13403 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013405connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13406 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013407 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013408 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13409 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013410
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013411 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013412 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013413 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13414
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013415 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13416 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013417
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013418 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013419 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013420 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013421 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13422 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013423 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013424 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013425
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013426 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13427 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013428 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013429 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013430
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013431date([<offset>]) : integer
13432 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13433 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13434 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13435 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013436 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13437
13438 Example :
13439
13440 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13441 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013442
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013443distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13444 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13445 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13446 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13447 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13448 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13449 list of supported tokens.
13450
13451distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13452 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13453 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13454 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13455 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13456 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13457 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13458 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13459 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13460 supported tokens.
13461
13462 Example :
13463 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13464 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13465 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13466 # send large files to the big farm
13467 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13468
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013469env(<name>) : string
13470 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13471 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13472 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13473 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13474 certain way.
13475
13476 Examples :
13477 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13478 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13479
13480 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13481 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013483fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13484 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013485 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13486 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013487 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13488 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13489 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13490 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13491 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013492
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013493fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13494 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13495 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13496 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013498fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13499 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13500 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13501 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13502 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13503 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13504 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13505 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13506 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013507
13508 Example :
13509 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13510 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13511 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13512 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13513 frontend mail
13514 bind :25
13515 mode tcp
13516 maxconn 100
13517 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13518 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13519 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13520 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013521
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013522hostname : string
13523 Returns the system hostname.
13524
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013525int(<integer>) : signed integer
13526 Returns a signed integer.
13527
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013528ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13529 Returns an ipv4.
13530
13531ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13532 Returns an ipv6.
13533
13534meth(<method>) : method
13535 Returns a method.
13536
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013537nbproc : integer
13538 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13539 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13540 and debugging purposes.
13541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013542nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13543 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13544 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13545 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013546 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13547 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13548 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013549
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013550proc : integer
13551 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13552 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13553 debugging purposes.
13554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013555queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013556 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13557 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13558 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013559 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13560 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13561 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13562 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13563 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13564
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013565rand([<range>]) : integer
13566 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13567 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13568 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13569 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13570 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013572srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13573 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13574 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13575 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13576 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13577 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13578 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13579 methods.
13580
13581srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13582 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13583 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13584 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13585 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13586 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13587 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13588 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13589
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013590srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13592 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13593 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13594 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13595 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13596 fetch methods.
13597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013598srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13599 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13600 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013601 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013602 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13603 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13604 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13605 overloading servers).
13606
13607 Example :
13608 # Redirect to a separate back
13609 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13610 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13611 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13612
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013613stopping : boolean
13614 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13615 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13616 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13617
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013618str(<string>) : string
13619 Returns a string.
13620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013621table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13622 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13623 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13624
13625table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13626 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13627 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13628 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13629
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010013630thread : integer
13631 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
13632 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
13633 and debugging purposes.
13634
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013635var(<var-name>) : undefined
13636 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013637 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13638 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013639 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013640 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13641 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013642 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013643 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13644 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013645 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013646 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013647
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136487.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013649----------------------------------
13650
13651The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13652closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13653methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13654sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13655TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013656the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13657counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13658"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013659argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13660the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13661this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013662
13663be_id : integer
13664 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13665 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13666
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013667be_name : string
13668 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13669 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013671dst : ip
13672 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13673 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13674 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13675 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13676 RFC 4291.
13677
13678dst_conn : integer
13679 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13680 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13681 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13682 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13683 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13684 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13685 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13686 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013687
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013688dst_is_local : boolean
13689 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13690 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13691 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13692 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13693 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13694 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13695 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13696 it only once per connection.
13697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013698dst_port : integer
13699 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13700 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13701 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13702 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13703 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13704 an HTTP header.
13705
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020013706fc_http_major : integer
13707 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
13708 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
13709 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
13710
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013711fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13712 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13713 header.
13714
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013715fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13716 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13717 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13718 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13719 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13720 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13721 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13722
13723fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13724 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13725 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13726 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13727 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13728 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13729 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13730
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013731fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13732 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13733 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13734 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13735 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13736
13737fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13738 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13739 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13740 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13741 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13742
13743fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13744 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13745 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13746 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13747 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13748
13749fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13750 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13751 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13752 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13753 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13754
13755fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13756 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13757 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13758 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13759 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13760
13761fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13762 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13763 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13764 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13765 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013767fe_id : integer
13768 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013769 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013770 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13771
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013772fe_name : string
13773 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13774 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13775 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013777sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013778sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13779sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13780sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013781 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13782 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13783 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13784
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013785sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013786sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13787sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13788sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013789 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13790 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13791 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13792
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013793sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013794sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13795sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13796sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013797 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13798 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013799 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13800 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13801 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013802
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013803 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013804 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13805 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013806 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13807 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13808 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013809 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13810 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13811
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013812sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013813sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13814sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13815sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013816 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13817 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13818
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013819sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013820sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13821sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13822sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013823 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13824 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13825 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013827sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013828sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13829sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13830sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013831 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13832 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13833 See also src_conn_rate.
13834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013835sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013836sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13837sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13838sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013839 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013840 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013841
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013842sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13843sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13844sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13845sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13846 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13847 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13848
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013849sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013850sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13851sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13852sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013853 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13854 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13855 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013856 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13857 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13858 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013859
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013860sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013861sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13862sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13863sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013864 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13865 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13866 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13867
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013868sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013869sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13870sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13871sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013872 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13873 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13874 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13875 src_http_err_rate.
13876
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013877sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013878sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13879sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13880sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013881 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13882 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13883 src_http_req_cnt.
13884
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013885sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013886sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13887sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13888sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013889 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13890 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13891 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13892 src_http_req_rate.
13893
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013894sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013895sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13896sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13897sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013898 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013899 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13900 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13901 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13902 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013903
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013904 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013905 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13906 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013907 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13908
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013909sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013910sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13911sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13912sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013913 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13914 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13915 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013916
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013917sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013918sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13919sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13920sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013921 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13922 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13923 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013924
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013925sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013926sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13927sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13928sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013929 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13930 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13931 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13932 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013933 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013934 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13935
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013936sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013937sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13938sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13939sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013940 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13941 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13942 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13943 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13944 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013945 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013946
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013947sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013948sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13949sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13950sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013951 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13952 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13953 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13954
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013955sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013956sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13957sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13958sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013959 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13960 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013961 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013962 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13963 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013964 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13965 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13966 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013968so_id : integer
13969 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13970 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13971 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013973src : ip
13974 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13975 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13976 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13977 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013978 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13979 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13980 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13981 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013982
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013983 Example:
13984 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13985 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013987src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13988 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13989 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13990 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013991 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13994 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13995 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013996 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013997 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14000 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14001 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14002 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14003 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14004 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14005 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014006
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014007 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014008 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14009 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14010 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14011 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014012 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014013 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14014 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014016src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014017 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014019 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014020 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014022src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014023 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014024 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14025 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014026 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14029 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14030 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14031 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014032 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014035 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014036 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014037 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014038 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014039
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014040src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14041 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14042 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14043 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14044 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014046src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014047 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014048 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014049 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14050 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014051 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14052 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14053 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014055src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14056 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
14057 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014058 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014059 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014060 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014062src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14063 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14064 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14065 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14066 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014067 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014069src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14070 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14071 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14072 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014073 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014075src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14076 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14077 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14078 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014079 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014080 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14083 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14084 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14085 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014086 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14088 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014089
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014090 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014091 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014092 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014093 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014094
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014095src_is_local : boolean
14096 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14097 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14098 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14099 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
14100 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
14101 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14102 once per connection.
14103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014104src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014105 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14106 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14107 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14108 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14109 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014111src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014112 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14113 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14114 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14115 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14116 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014118src_port : integer
14119 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14120 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14121 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14122 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014124src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14125 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014126 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14127 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14128 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014129 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014131src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14132 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14133 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14134 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14135 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014136 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014138src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14139 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14140 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14141 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14142 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14143 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14144 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14145 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14146 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014147
14148 Example :
14149 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14150 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14151 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14152 listen ssh
14153 bind :22
14154 mode tcp
14155 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014156 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014157 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014158 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014160srv_id : integer
14161 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14162 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14163 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014164
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141657.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014166----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014168The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14169closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14170when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14171usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014172future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014173
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001417451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14175 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14176 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14177 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14178 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14179 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14180
14181 Example :
14182 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14183 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14184 # the request.
14185 frontend http-in
14186 bind *:8081
14187 default_backend servers
14188 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14189 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14190
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014191ssl_bc : boolean
14192 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14193 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14194 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14195
14196ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14197 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14198 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14199
14200ssl_bc_cipher : string
14201 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14202 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14203
14204ssl_bc_protocol : string
14205 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14206 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14207
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014208ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014209 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014210 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14211 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014212
14213ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14214 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14215 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14216 if session was reused or not.
14217
14218ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14219 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14220 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014222ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14223 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14224 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14225 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14226 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14227 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014229ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14230 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14231 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14232 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14233 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014234
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014235ssl_c_der : binary
14236 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14237 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14238 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014240ssl_c_err : integer
14241 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14242 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14243 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14244 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14245 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014247ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14248 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14249 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14250 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14251 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14252 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14253 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14254 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14255 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257ssl_c_key_alg : string
14258 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14259 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14260 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262ssl_c_notafter : string
14263 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14264 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14265 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014267ssl_c_notbefore : string
14268 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14269 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14270 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14273 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14274 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14275 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14276 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14277 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14278 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14279 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14280 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014282ssl_c_serial : binary
14283 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14284 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14285 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014287ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14288 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14289 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14290 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014291 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14292 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14293
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014294 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014295 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014297ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14298 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14299 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14300 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302ssl_c_used : boolean
14303 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14304 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306ssl_c_verify : integer
14307 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14308 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14309 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14310 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312ssl_c_version : integer
14313 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14314 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014315
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014316ssl_f_der : binary
14317 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14318 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14319 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014321ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14322 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14323 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14324 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14325 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014326 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014327 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14328 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14329 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331ssl_f_key_alg : string
14332 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14333 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14334 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014336ssl_f_notafter : string
14337 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14338 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14339 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014341ssl_f_notbefore : string
14342 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14343 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14344 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014346ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14347 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14348 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14349 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14350 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14351 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14352 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14353 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14354 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014356ssl_f_serial : binary
14357 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14358 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14359 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014360
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014361ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14362 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14363 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14364 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014366ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14367 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14368 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14369 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371ssl_f_version : integer
14372 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14373 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14374
14375ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014376 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14377 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14378 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380 Example :
14381 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14382 listen http-https
14383 bind :80
14384 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14385 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14386
14387ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14388 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14389 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14390
14391ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014392 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014393 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14394 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14395 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14396 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14397 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14398 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14399 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14400 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014402ssl_fc_cipher : string
14403 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14404 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014405
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014406ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14407 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14408 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014409 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014410
14411ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14412 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14413 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014414 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014415
14416ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14417 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14418 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14419 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014420 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14421 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014422
14423ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14424 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14425 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014426 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014429 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14430 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014431 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14432 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14433 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14434 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014435
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014436ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14437 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14438 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14439 wait until the handshake happened.
14440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014441ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14442 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014443 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14444 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14445 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14446 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014447
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014448ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014449 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14450 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014452ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014453 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014454 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14455 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14456 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14457 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14458 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14459 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14460 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014462ssl_fc_protocol : string
14463 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14464 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014465
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014466ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014467 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014468 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14469 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014471ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14472 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14473 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14474 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14475 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477ssl_fc_sni : string
14478 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14479 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14480 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14481 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14482 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14483
14484 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14485 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14486 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014487 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14488 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014490 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014491 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14492 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014494ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14495 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14496 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014497
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014498
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144997.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014502Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14503sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14504only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14505For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14506be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14507can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14508sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14509for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14510content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14513 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14514 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14515 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14518 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14519 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14520 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014521
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014522req.hdrs : string
14523 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14524 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14525 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14526 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14527
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014528req.hdrs_bin : binary
14529 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14530 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14531 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14532 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14533 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14534 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14535
14536 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14537
14538 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14539 str: <int:length><bytes>
14540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014541req.len : integer
14542req_len : integer (deprecated)
14543 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14544 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14545 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14546 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14547 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14548 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14549 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14550 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14553 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014554 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14555 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14556 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14557 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014559 ACL alternatives :
14560 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14563 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14564 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14565 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14566 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014568 ACL alternatives :
14569 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014573req.proto_http : boolean
14574req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14575 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14576 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14577 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14578 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14579 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14580 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14581 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583 Example:
14584 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14585 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14586 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014587 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014589req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14590rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14591 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14592 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14593 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14594 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14595 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14596 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14597 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014599 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14600 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14601 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14602 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14603 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14604 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014606 ACL derivatives :
14607 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609 Example :
14610 listen tse-farm
14611 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14612 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14613 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14614 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14615 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14616 persist rdp-cookie
14617 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14618 # This is only useful makes sense if
14619 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14620 stick-table type string size 204800
14621 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14622 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14623 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014625 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14626 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014628req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14629rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14630 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14631 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14632 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14633 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635 ACL derivatives :
14636 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014637
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014638req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14639 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14640 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014641 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14642 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14643 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14644 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14645 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14648req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14649 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14650 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14651 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14652 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14653 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14654 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14655 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014657req.ssl_sni : string
14658req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14659 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14660 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14661 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14662 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14663 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14664 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14665 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14666 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14667 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14668 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14669 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14670 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014672 ACL derivatives :
14673 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014675 Examples :
14676 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14677 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14678 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14679 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14680 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014681
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014682req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14683 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14684 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14685 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14686 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14687 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14688 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14689 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14690 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14691 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014693req.ssl_ver : integer
14694req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14695 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14696 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14697 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14698 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14699 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14700 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14701 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14702 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14703 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014705 ACL derivatives :
14706 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014707
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014708res.len : integer
14709 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14710 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14711 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14712 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14713 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14714 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14715 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14716 content inspection.
14717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014718res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14719 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014720 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14721 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14722 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14723 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014725res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14726 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14727 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14728 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14729 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014731 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014732
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014733res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14734rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14735 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14736 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14737 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14738 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14739 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14740 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14741 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014743wait_end : boolean
14744 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14745 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14746 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14747 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14748 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14749 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14750 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14751 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014753 Examples :
14754 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14755 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14756 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014758 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14759 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14760 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14761 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14762 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14763 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14764 tcp-request content reject
14765
14766
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200147677.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768--------------------------------------
14769
14770It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14771This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14772data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14773its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14774HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14775content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14776to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14777more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14778response are indexed.
14779
14780base : string
14781 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14782 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14783 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14784 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14785 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14786 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14787 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14788 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14789
14790 ACL derivatives :
14791 base : exact string match
14792 base_beg : prefix match
14793 base_dir : subdir match
14794 base_dom : domain match
14795 base_end : suffix match
14796 base_len : length match
14797 base_reg : regex match
14798 base_sub : substring match
14799
14800base32 : integer
14801 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14802 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14803 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014804 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14805 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14806 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807
14808base32+src : binary
14809 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14810 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14811 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14812 per-URL counters.
14813
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014814capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14815 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14816 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14817 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14818
14819capture.req.method : string
14820 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14821 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14822 because it's allocated.
14823
14824capture.req.uri : string
14825 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14826 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14827 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14828 allocated.
14829
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014830capture.req.ver : string
14831 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14832 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14833 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14834
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014835capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14836 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14837 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14838 The first entry is an index of 0.
14839 See also: "capture response header"
14840
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014841capture.res.ver : string
14842 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14843 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14844 persistent flag.
14845
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014846req.body : binary
14847 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14848 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14849 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14850 the first chunk is analyzed.
14851
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014852req.body_param([<name>) : string
14853 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14854 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14855 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14856 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14857 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14858 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14859 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14860 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14861 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14862 given.
14863
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014864req.body_len : integer
14865 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14866 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14867 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14868 "option http-buffer-request".
14869
14870req.body_size : integer
14871 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14872 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14873 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14874 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14875 "option http-buffer-request".
14876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877req.cook([<name>]) : string
14878cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14879 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14880 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14881 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14882 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14883 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14884 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14885 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14886 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14887
14888 ACL derivatives :
14889 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14890 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14891 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14892 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14893 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14894 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14895 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14896 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14899cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14900 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14901 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014903req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14904cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14905 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14906 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14907 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14908 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014910cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14911 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14912 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14913 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14914 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014915 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014916 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14917 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14918 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14919 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014921hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14922 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14923 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14924 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14925 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014926 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014928req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14929 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14930 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14931 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14932 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14933 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14934 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14935 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14936 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14939 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14940 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14941 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14942 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014944req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14945 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14946 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14947 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14948 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14949 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14950 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14951 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14952 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014953 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014954 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14955 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957 ACL derivatives :
14958 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14959 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14960 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14961 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14962 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14963 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14964 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14965 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14966
14967req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14968hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14969 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14970 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14971 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14972 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14973 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14974 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14975 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14976 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14977 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14978
14979req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14980hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14981 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14982 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14983 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14984 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14985 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14986 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14987 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14988 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14989
14990req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14991hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14992 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14993 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14994 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14995 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14996 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14997 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14998 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14999
15000http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15001 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15002 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15003 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15004 basic auth is supported.
15005
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015006http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15007 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15008 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15009 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15010 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015011 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15012 basic auth is supported.
15013
15014 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015015 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15016 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15017 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15018 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015019
15020http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015021 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15022 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015023 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15024 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015026method : integer + string
15027 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15028 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15029 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15030 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15031 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15032 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15033 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015035 ACL derivatives :
15036 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015038 Example :
15039 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15040 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15041 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015043path : string
15044 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15045 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15046 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15047 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15048 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
15049 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
15050 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015052 ACL derivatives :
15053 path : exact string match
15054 path_beg : prefix match
15055 path_dir : subdir match
15056 path_dom : domain match
15057 path_end : suffix match
15058 path_len : length match
15059 path_reg : regex match
15060 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015061
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015062query : string
15063 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15064 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15065 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15066 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015067 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015068 which stops before the question mark.
15069
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015070req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15071 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15072 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15073 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15074 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076req.ver : string
15077req_ver : string (deprecated)
15078 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
15079 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
15080 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082 ACL derivatives :
15083 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015085res.comp : boolean
15086 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
15087 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
15088 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015090res.comp_algo : string
15091 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
15092 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
15093 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015095res.cook([<name>]) : string
15096scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15097 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15098 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15099 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015101 ACL derivatives :
15102 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020015103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15105scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15106 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15107 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
15108 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015110res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15111scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15112 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15113 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15114 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015116res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15117 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15118 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15119 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15120 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15121 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15122 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15123 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15124 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15125 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015127res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15128 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15129 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15130 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15131 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15132 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015134res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15135shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15136 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15137 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15138 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15139 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15140 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15141 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15142 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15143 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015145 ACL derivatives :
15146 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15147 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15148 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15149 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15150 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15151 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15152 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15153 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15154
15155res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15156shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15157 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15158 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15159 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15160 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15161 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015163res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15164shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15165 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15166 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15167 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15168 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15169 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15170 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015171
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015172res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15173 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15174 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15175 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15176 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015178res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15179shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15180 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15181 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15182 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15183 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15184 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15185 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187res.ver : string
15188resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15189 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15190 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015192 ACL derivatives :
15193 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15196 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15197 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015198 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015199 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015201 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15202 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015204status : integer
15205 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15206 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15207 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015208
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015209unique-id : string
15210 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15211 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15212 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15213 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15214 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15215 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015217url : string
15218 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15219 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15220 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15221 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15222 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15223 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15224 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015226 ACL derivatives :
15227 url : exact string match
15228 url_beg : prefix match
15229 url_dir : subdir match
15230 url_dom : domain match
15231 url_end : suffix match
15232 url_len : length match
15233 url_reg : regex match
15234 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236url_ip : ip
15237 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15238 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15239 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15240 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15241 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15242 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15243 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245url_port : integer
15246 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15247 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15248 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15249 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015250
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015251urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15252url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015253 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15254 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015255 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15256 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15257 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15258 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015259 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15260 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015261 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15262 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264 ACL derivatives :
15265 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15266 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15267 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15268 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15269 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15270 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15271 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15272 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015273
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275 Example :
15276 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15277 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15278 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15279 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015280
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015281urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015282 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15283 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15284 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015285
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015286url32 : integer
15287 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15288 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15289 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15290 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15291 is an unsigned integer.
15292
15293url32+src : binary
15294 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15295 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15296 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15297
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152997.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015300---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015302Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15303every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015304order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015306ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15307---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015308FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015309HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015310HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15311HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015312HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15313HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15314HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15315HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15316LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015317METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015318METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015319METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15320METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15321METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15322METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015323METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015324METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015325RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015326REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015327TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015328WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15329---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015330
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153328. Logging
15333----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015334
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015335One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15336provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15337very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15338provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15339state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015340to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015341headers.
15342
15343In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15344about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15345send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15346
15347 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15348 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15349 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15350 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15351 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015352 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15353 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015354
15355The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15356allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15357as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15358while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15359real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15360delay.
15361
15362
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153638.1. Log levels
15364---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015365
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015366TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015367source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015368HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15369in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15370track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15371syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15372about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015373
15374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153758.2. Log formats
15376----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015377
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015378HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015379and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15380slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15381options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015382
15383 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15384 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15385 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15386 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15387 extents.
15388
15389 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15390 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15391 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15392 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15393 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15394
15395 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15396 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15397 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15398 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15399 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15400
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015401 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15402 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15403 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15404 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15405
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015406 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15407
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015408Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15409specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15410field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15411servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15412always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15413identifier.
15414
15415Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15416 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15417 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15418 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15419 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15420
15421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154228.2.1. Default log format
15423-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015424
15425This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15426as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15427format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15428
15429 Example :
15430 listen www
15431 mode http
15432 log global
15433 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15434
15435 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15436 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15437 (www/HTTP)
15438
15439 Field Format Extract from the example above
15440 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15441 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15442 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15443 4 'to' to
15444 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15445 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15446
15447Detailed fields description :
15448 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15449 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15450 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15451 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15452 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15453 and processed the connection.
15454 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15455
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015456In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15457"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15458connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15459
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015460It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15461will eventually disappear.
15462
15463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154648.2.2. TCP log format
15465---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015466
15467The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15468is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15469information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15470counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15471emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15472environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15473the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15474sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015475specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15476not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15477fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15478marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015479
15480 Example :
15481 frontend fnt
15482 mode tcp
15483 option tcplog
15484 log global
15485 default_backend bck
15486
15487 backend bck
15488 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15489
15490 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15491 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15492 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15493
15494 Field Format Extract from the example above
15495 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15496 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15497 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15498 4 frontend_name fnt
15499 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15500 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15501 7 bytes_read* 212
15502 8 termination_state --
15503 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15504 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15505
15506Detailed fields description :
15507 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015508 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15509 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15510 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015511 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15512 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15513 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015514
15515 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015516 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15517 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15518 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015519
15520 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15521 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15522 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15523 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15524
15525 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15526 and processed the connection.
15527
15528 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15529 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15530 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15531 applications.
15532
15533 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15534 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15535 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15536 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15537 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15538
15539 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15540 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15541 See "Timers" below for more details.
15542
15543 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15544 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15545 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15546 "Timers" below for more details.
15547
15548 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015549 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015550 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15551 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15552 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15553 details.
15554
15555 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15556 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15557 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15558 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15559 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15560
15561 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15562 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15563 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15564 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15565 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15566 for more details.
15567
15568 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015569 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015570 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15571 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15572 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015573 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015574
15575 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15576 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15577 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15578 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15579 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15580 caused by a denial of service attack.
15581
15582 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15583 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15584 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15585 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15586 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15587 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15588 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15589 denial of service attack.
15590
15591 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15592 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15593 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15594 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15595 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15596 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15597 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15598 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15599 be processed than on other servers.
15600
15601 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15602 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15603 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15604 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15605 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15606 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15607 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15608 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15609 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15610 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15611 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15612 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15613 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15614
15615 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15616 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15617 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15618 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15619 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15620 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15621 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15622 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15623
15624 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15625 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15626 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15627 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15628 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15629 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15630 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15631 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15632 occurs.
15633
15634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156358.2.3. HTTP log format
15636----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015637
15638The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15639is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15640the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15641are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15642emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15643generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15644"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15645which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015646frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15647is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015648
15649Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15650slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15651with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15652
15653 Example :
15654 frontend http-in
15655 mode http
15656 option httplog
15657 log global
15658 default_backend bck
15659
15660 backend static
15661 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15662
15663 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15664 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15665 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015666 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015667
15668 Field Format Extract from the example above
15669 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15670 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015671 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015672 4 frontend_name http-in
15673 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015674 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015675 7 status_code 200
15676 8 bytes_read* 2750
15677 9 captured_request_cookie -
15678 10 captured_response_cookie -
15679 11 termination_state ----
15680 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15681 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15682 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15683 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15684 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015685
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015686Detailed fields description :
15687 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015688 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15689 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15690 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015691 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15692 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15693 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015694
15695 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015696 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15697 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15698 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015699
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015700 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15701 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015702
15703 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15704 and processed the connection.
15705
15706 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15707 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15708 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15709
15710 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15711 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15712 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15713 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15714 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15715 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15716
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015717 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15718 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15719 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15720 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15721 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15722 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15723 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015724
15725 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15726 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15727 See "Timers" below for more details.
15728
15729 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15730 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15731 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15732 below for more details.
15733
15734 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15735 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15736 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15737 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15738 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15739 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15740 for more details.
15741
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015742 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15743 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15744 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15745 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15746 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15747 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15748 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15749 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015750
15751 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15752 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15753 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15754
15755 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15756 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15757 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15758 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15759 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15760 overflowing.
15761
15762 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15763 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15764 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15765 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15766 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15767 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15768 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15769 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15770
15771 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15772 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15773 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15774 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15775 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15776 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15777 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15778 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15779
15780 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15781 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15782 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15783 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15784 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15785 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15786 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15787
15788 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015789 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015790 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15791 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15792 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015793 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015794 system.
15795
15796 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15797 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15798 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15799 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15800 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15801 caused by a denial of service attack.
15802
15803 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15804 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15805 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15806 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15807 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15808 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15809 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15810 denial of service attack.
15811
15812 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15813 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15814 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15815 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15816 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15817 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15818 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15819 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15820 processed than on other servers.
15821
15822 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15823 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15824 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15825 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15826 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15827 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15828 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15829 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15830 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15831 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15832 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15833 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15834 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15835
15836 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15837 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15838 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15839 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15840 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15841 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15842 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15843 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15844
15845 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15846 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15847 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15848 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15849 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15850 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15851 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15852 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15853 occurs.
15854
15855 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15856 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15857 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15858 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15859 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15860 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15861 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15862 cookies" below for more details.
15863
15864 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15865 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15866 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15867 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15868 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15869 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15870 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15871 and cookies" below for more details.
15872
15873 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15874 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15875 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15876 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15877 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15878 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15879 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15880 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15881
15882
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200158838.2.4. Custom log format
15884------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015885
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015886The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015887mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015888
15889HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15890Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15891separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15892prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15893
15894Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15895variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015896("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015897
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015898If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015899as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015900less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15901the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15902
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015903Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015904In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015905in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015906
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015907Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15908'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15909https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15910such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15911
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015912Flags are :
15913 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015914 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015915 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15916 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015917
15918 Example:
15919
15920 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15921 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15922
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015923 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15924
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015925At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15926
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015927 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15928 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015929
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015930the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015931
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015932 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15933 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15934 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015935
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015936and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15937
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015938 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15939 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015940
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015941Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15942
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015943 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015944 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015945 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15946 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15947 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015948 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15949 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15950 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015951 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015952 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15953 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015954 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015955 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15956 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015957 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015958 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015959 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015960 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015961 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015962 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015963 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015964 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15965 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15966 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15967 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15968 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015969 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015970 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15971 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015972 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015973 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15974 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015975 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15976 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15977 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015978 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015979 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15980 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015981 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015982 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15983 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15984 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015985 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015986 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015987 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15988 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15989 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15990 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015991 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015992 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015993 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015994 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015995 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015996 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015997 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15998 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15999 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016000 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016001 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16002 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016003 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016004 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16005 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
16006 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016007 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016008 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016009 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016010
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016011 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016012
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016013
160148.2.5. Error log format
16015-----------------------
16016
16017When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16018protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16019By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16020"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
16021will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
16022logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16023
16024The format looks like this :
16025
16026 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16027 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16028 Connection error during SSL handshake
16029
16030 Field Format Extract from the example above
16031 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16032 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16033 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16034 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16035 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16036
16037These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16038failures.
16039
16040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160418.3. Advanced logging options
16042-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016043
16044Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16045just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16046options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16047for more information about their usage.
16048
16049
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160508.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16051------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016052
16053It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16054haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16055commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16056monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16057ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16058
16059 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16060 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16061 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16062 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
16063
16064 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
16065 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
16066 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016067 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016068 such as other load-balancers.
16069
16070 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
16071 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
16072 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
16073
16074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160758.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
16076----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016077
16078The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
16079what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
16080or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
16081"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
16082just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
16083log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
16084after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
16085is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
16086with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
16087with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
16088
16089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160908.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
16091------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016092
16093Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
16094for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
16095"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
16096retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
16097raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
16098a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
16099file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
16100you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
16101"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
16102
16103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161048.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
16105--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016106
16107Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
16108multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
16109them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
16110"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
16111logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
16112error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16113and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16114too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16115useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16116alternative.
16117
16118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161198.4. Timing events
16120------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016121
16122Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16123reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16124the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16125frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016126mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16127addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16128
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016129Timings events in HTTP mode:
16130
16131 first request 2nd request
16132 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16133 t tr t tr ...
16134 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16135 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16136 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16137 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16138 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16139
16140Timings events in TCP mode:
16141
16142 TCP session
16143 |<----------------->|
16144 t t
16145 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16146 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16147 |<------ Tt ------->|
16148
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016149 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16150 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16151 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16152 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16153 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16154 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16155 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016156
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016157 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16158 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16159 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16160 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16161 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16162 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16163 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16164 nothing was received on the connection.
16165
16166 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16167 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16168 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16169 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16170 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16171 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16172 request typed by hand during a test.
16173
16174 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16175 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16176 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16177 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16178 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16179 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16180 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016181
16182 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16183 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16184 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16185 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16186 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16187
16188 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16189 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16190 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16191 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16192 connection never established.
16193
16194 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16195 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16196 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16197 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16198 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16199 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16200 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16201 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16202 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16203 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16204 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16205
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016206 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16207 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16208 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16209 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16210 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16211 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16212
16213 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16214
16215 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16216 "Ta" can never be negative.
16217
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016218 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16219 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016220 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16221 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016222 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016223
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016224 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016225
16226 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016227 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16228 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016229
16230These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16231protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16232that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016233due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16234"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16235that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016236
16237Most common cases :
16238
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016239 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16240 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16241 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16242 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16243 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16244 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16245 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16246 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16247 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16248 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16249 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016250 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016251
16252 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16253 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16254 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16255 of ms on remote networks.
16256
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016257 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16258 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16259 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016260
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016261 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16262 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16263 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16264 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16265 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16266 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16267 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16268 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16269 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016270
16271Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16272
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016273 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016274 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016275 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016276
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016277 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016278 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16279 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16280
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016281 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016282 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16283 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16284 flags.
16285
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016286 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16287 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016288 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16289 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16290 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16291 the client connection was maintained open.
16292
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016293 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016294 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016295 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016296 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16297
16298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162998.5. Session state at disconnection
16300-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016301
16302TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16303"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
163042-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16305each of which has a special meaning :
16306
16307 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16308 session to terminate :
16309
16310 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16311
16312 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16313 server explicitly refused it.
16314
16315 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16316 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16317 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16318 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016319 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16320
16321 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16322 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016323
16324 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16325 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16326 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16327 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16328 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16329
16330 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16331 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16332 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16333 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16334 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16335
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016336 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16337 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16338
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016339 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16340 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16341 backup connections when going up.
16342
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016343 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16344
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016345 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16346 send or receive data.
16347
16348 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16349 send or receive data.
16350
16351 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16352 with nothing left in the buffers.
16353
16354 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16355
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016356 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016357 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16358
16359 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16360 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16361 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16362 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16363 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16364
16365 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16366 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16367
16368 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16369 server (HTTP only).
16370
16371 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16372
16373 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16374 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16375 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16376
16377 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16378 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16379 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16380
16381 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16382
16383 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16384 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16385
16386 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16387 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16388 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16389
16390 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16391 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016392 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16393 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016394
16395 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16396 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16397 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16398 another server.
16399
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016400 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016401 server.
16402
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016403 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16404 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16405 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16406 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16407
16408 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16409 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16410 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16411 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16412
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016413 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16414 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16415 "use-server" rule).
16416
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016417 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16418
16419 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16420 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16421
16422 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16423
16424 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16425 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16426 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16427
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016428 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16429 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016430 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016431 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16432 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16433
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016434 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16435
16436 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16437 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16438
16439 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16440
16441 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16442
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016443The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16444was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016445helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16446starvation, attacks, etc...
16447
16448The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16449alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16450easier finding and understanding.
16451
16452 Flags Reason
16453
16454 -- Normal termination.
16455
16456 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16457 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16458 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16459 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16460
16461 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16462 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16463 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16464 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16465 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16466 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016467
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016468 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16469 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016470 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016471
16472 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16473 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16474 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16475
16476 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16477 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16478 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16479 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16480 the server takes too long to respond.
16481
16482 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16483 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16484 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16485 long a time to respond.
16486
16487 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16488 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16489 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16490 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016491 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16492 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016493
16494 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16495 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16496 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16497 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16498 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016499 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016500 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16501 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16502 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16503 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16504 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16505 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16506 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16507 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16508 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16509 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16510 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16511 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016512
16513 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16514 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016515 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16516 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16517 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16518 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016519
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016520 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16521 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016523 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016524 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16525 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16526 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16527 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16528 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16529
16530 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16531 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16532 503 or 504 here.
16533
16534 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16535 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16536 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16537 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16538 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16539
16540 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16541 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016542 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016543 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16544 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16545
16546 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16547 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16548 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16549 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16550 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16551 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16552 between haproxy and the server.
16553
16554 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16555 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16556 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16557 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16558 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16559 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16560 solution is to fix the application.
16561
16562 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16563 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16564 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16565 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16566 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16567 external attacks.
16568
16569 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16570 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016571 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016572 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16573 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16574
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016575 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16576 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16577 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016578 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16579 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016580
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016581 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16582 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16583 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16584 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016585 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16586 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16587 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16588 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16589 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016590
16591 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16592 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16593 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16594 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16595
16596 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16597 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16598 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16599 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16600
16601 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16602 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16603 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16604 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16605
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016606The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16607persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16608important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16609re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16610
16611 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16612
16613 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16614 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16615 set on a GET request.
16616
16617 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16618 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016619 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016620 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16621
16622 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16623 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16624 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16625
16626 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16627 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16628 already got a cookie.
16629
16630 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16631 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16632 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16633 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16634 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16635
16636 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16637 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16638 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16639
16640 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16641 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16642 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16643
16644 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16645 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16646
16647 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16648 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16649 then advertised in the response.
16650
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166528.6. Non-printable characters
16653-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016654
16655In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16656consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16657converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16658prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16659being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16660escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16661is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16662'}' when logging headers.
16663
16664Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16665issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16666containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16667
16668Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16669the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16670performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16671
16672
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166738.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16674---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016675
16676Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16677achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016678section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016679cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16680the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16681the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016682locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016683not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16684user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16685a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16686wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16687
16688 Examples :
16689 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16690 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16691
16692 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16693 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16694
16695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166968.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16697---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016698
16699Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16700proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16701the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16702server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16703
16704Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16705response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016706section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016707
16708It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016709time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16710appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016711are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16712and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16713follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16714request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16715in the logs.
16716
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016717As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16718frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16719an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16720
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016721 Example :
16722 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16723 listen proxy-out
16724 mode http
16725 option httplog
16726 option logasap
16727 log global
16728 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16729
16730 # log the name of the virtual server
16731 capture request header Host len 20
16732
16733 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16734 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16735
16736 # log the beginning of the referrer
16737 capture request header Referer len 20
16738
16739 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16740 capture response header Server len 20
16741
16742 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16743 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16744
16745 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16746 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16747
16748 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16749 capture response header Via len 20
16750
16751 # log the URL location during a redirection
16752 capture response header Location len 20
16753
16754 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16755 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16756 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16757 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16758 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16759
16760 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16761 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16762 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16763 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016764 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016765
16766 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16767 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16768 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16769 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16770 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016771 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016772
16773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167748.9. Examples of logs
16775---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016776
16777These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16778them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16779reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16780
16781 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16782 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16783 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16784
16785 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16786 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16787
16788 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16789 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16790 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16791
16792 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16793 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16794
16795 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16796 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16797 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16798
16799 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016800 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016801 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16802 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16803
16804 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16805 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16806 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16807
16808 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16809 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016810 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016811 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16812 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16813 to return the 502 and not the server.
16814
16815 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016816 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016817
16818 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16819 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16820 Nothing was sent to any server.
16821
16822 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16823 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16824
16825 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16826 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16827 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16828 send a 408 return code to the client.
16829
16830 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16831 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16832
16833 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16834 5 seconds ("c----").
16835
16836 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16837 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016838 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016839
16840 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016841 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016842 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16843 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16844 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16845 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16846 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016847
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016848
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200168499. Supported filters
16850--------------------
16851
16852Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16853accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16854unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16855
16856See also : "filter"
16857
168589.1. Trace
16859----------
16860
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016861filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016862
16863 Arguments:
16864 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16865 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16866
16867 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16868 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16869 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16870 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16871
16872 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16873 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16874 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16875 amount of the parsed data.
16876
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016877 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16878
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016879This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16880callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16881information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16882filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16883
16884Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16885tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16886a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16887
16888
168899.2. HTTP compression
16890---------------------
16891
16892filter compression
16893
16894The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16895keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16896when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16897use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16898used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16899filters evaluation order.
16900
16901See also : "compression"
16902
16903
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200169049.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16905--------------------------------------------
16906
16907filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16908
16909 Arguments :
16910
16911 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16912 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16913 parsed.
16914
16915 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16916 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16917 part must be placed in its own scope.
16918
16919The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16920external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16921streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16922exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16923also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16924
16925SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16926the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16927
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016928For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016929"doc/SPOE.txt".
16930
16931Important note:
16932 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16933 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016935/*
16936 * Local variables:
16937 * fill-column: 79
16938 * End:
16939 */